blob: 3a7d1018c40c1784aa1f6b10b1ba254a56fa6541 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Duncan Sandsb84abcd2007-09-11 14:35:41 +000042#include "llvm/ParameterAttributes.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000048#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000049#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000050#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000051#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000052#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000053#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000059#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000060#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000061using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000062using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000063
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000064STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
65STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
68STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000069
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000070namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000071 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
72 : public FunctionPass,
73 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000074 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000075 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
76 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000077 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000078 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000079 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000080 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000081 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
82
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000083 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
84 /// isn't already in it.
85 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
86 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
87 Worklist.push_back(I);
88 }
89
90 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
91 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
92 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
93 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
94
95 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
96 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
97
98 WorklistMap.erase(It);
99 }
100
101 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
102 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
103 Worklist.pop_back();
104 WorklistMap.erase(I);
105 return I;
106 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000107
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000108
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000109 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
110 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
111 /// now.
112 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000113 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000114 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000115 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000116 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 }
118
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000119 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
120 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
121 ///
122 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
123 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
124 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000125 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000126 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000127
128 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
129 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
130 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
131 ///
132 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
133 ///
134 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
135 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
136
137 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
138 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000139 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000140 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
141 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
142 }
143
144 return R;
145 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000146
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000147 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000148 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000149
150 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000151
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000152 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000153 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000154 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000155 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000156 }
157
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000158 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
159
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000160 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
161 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
162 // Return Value:
163 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000164 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000165 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000166 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000167 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
169 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000170 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000175 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000180 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000183 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000187 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
188 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
189 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000190 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
191 Instruction *LHS,
192 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000193 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
194 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000195
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000196 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
197 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000198 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000199 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000200 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
201 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000202 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000203 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
205 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000206 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
213 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000214 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000215 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
216 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000217 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000218 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
219 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000220 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
221 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000222 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000223 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000224 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000225 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000226 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000227 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000228 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000229 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000230 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000231
232 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000233 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000234
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000235 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000236 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000237 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000238 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000239
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000240 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
242 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
243 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000244 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000245 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
246 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000247 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
248 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000249 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000250 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 }
252
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000253 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
254 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
255 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000256 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
257 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000258 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000259
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000260 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000261 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000262
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000263 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000264 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000265 return C;
266 }
267
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000268 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
269 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
270 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
271 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
272 // modified.
273 //
274 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000275 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000276 if (&I != V) {
277 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
278 return &I;
279 } else {
280 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
281 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000282 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000283 return &I;
284 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000285 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000286
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000287 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
288 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
289 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
290 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
291 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
292 //
293 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
294 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
295 if (Old != New)
296 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
297 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000298 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000299 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000300 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000301 return true;
302 }
303
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000304 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
305 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
306 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
307 // this function.
308 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
309 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
310 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000311 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000312 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000313 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
314 }
315
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000316 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000317 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
318 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
319 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
320 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000321 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
322 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000323 Instruction *InsertBefore);
324
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000325 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
326 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000327 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000328
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000329 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
330 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
331 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
332
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000333 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
334 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000335 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
336 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
337 unsigned Depth = 0);
338
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000339 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
340 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
341
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000342 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
343 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
344 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
345 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
346
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000347 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
348 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
349 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
350 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000351 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
352
353
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000354 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
355 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000356
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000357 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000358 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000359 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000360 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000361 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000362 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000363 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000364
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000365 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000366 };
Chris Lattnerf6293092002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000367
Devang Patel19974732007-05-03 01:11:54 +0000368 char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
Chris Lattner7f8897f2006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000369 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000370}
371
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000372// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000373// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000374static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
375 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
376 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000377 return 3;
378 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000379 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000380 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
381 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000382}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000383
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000384// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
385// it.
386static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000387 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000388}
389
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000390// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
391// though a va_arg area...
392static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000393 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
394 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
395 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000396 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000397 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000398}
399
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000400/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
401/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
402static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
403 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000404 return I->getOperand(0);
405 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000406 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000407 return CE->getOperand(0);
408 return 0;
409}
410
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000411/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
412/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000413static Instruction::CastOps
414isEliminableCastPair(
415 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
416 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
417 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
418 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
419) {
420
421 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
422 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000423
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000424 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
425 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
426 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000427
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000428 return Instruction::CastOps(
429 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
430 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000431}
432
433/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
434/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
435/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000436static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
437 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000438 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
439
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000440 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000441 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000442 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000443 return false;
444 return true;
445}
446
447/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
448/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
449/// casts that are known to not do anything...
450///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000451Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
452 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000453 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
454 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
455 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000456 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000457
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000458 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000461// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
462// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000463//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000464// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
465// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
466// binary operators.
467//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000468// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
469// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000470//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000471bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000472 bool Changed = false;
473 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
474 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000475
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000476 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
477 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000478 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
479 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
480 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000481 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
482 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
483 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000484 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
485 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
486 return true;
487 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
488 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
489 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
490 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
491 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
492
493 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000494 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000495 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
496 Op1->getOperand(0),
497 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000498 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000499 I.setOperand(0, New);
500 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
501 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000502 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000503 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000504 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000505}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000506
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000507/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
508/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
509/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
510bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
511 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
512 return false;
513 I.swapOperands();
514 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
515 return true;
516}
517
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000518// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
519// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000520//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000521static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
522 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000523 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000524
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000525 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
526 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
527 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000528 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000529}
530
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000531static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
532 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000533 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000534
535 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000536 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000537 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000538 return 0;
539}
540
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000541// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
542// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000543// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
544// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000545//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000546static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000547 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000548 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000549 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000550 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000551 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000552 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000553 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000554 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000555 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000556 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000557 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000558 return I->getOperand(0);
559 }
560 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000561 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000562}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000563
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000564/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
565/// expression, return it.
566static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
567 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
568 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
569 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
570 return cast<User>(V);
571 return false;
572}
573
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000574/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000575static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000576 APInt Val(C->getValue());
577 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000578}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000579/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000580static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000581 APInt Val(C->getValue());
582 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000583}
584/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
585static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
586 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
587}
588/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
589static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
590 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
591}
592/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
593static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
594 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
595}
596/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
597static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
598 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000599}
600
Chris Lattner68d5ff22006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000601/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
602/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000603/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
604/// processing.
605/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
606/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
607/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
608/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
609/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
610/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000611static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000612 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000613 assert(V && "No Value?");
614 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000615 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000616 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000617 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000618 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000619 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000620 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
621 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000622 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000623 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
624 return;
625 }
626
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000627 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
628 return; // Limit search depth.
629
630 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
631 if (!I) return;
632
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000633 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000634 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000635
636 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000637 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000638 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
639 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000640 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
641 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000642 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
643 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
644
645 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
646 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
647 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
648 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
649 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000650 }
651 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000652 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000653 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
654 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000655 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
656 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
657
658 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
659 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
660 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
661 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
662 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000663 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000664 case Instruction::Xor: {
665 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
666 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
667 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
668 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
669
670 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
671 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
672 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
673 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
674 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
675 return;
676 }
677 case Instruction::Select:
678 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
679 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
680 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
681 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
682
683 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
684 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
685 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
686 return;
687 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
688 case Instruction::FPExt:
689 case Instruction::FPToUI:
690 case Instruction::FPToSI:
691 case Instruction::SIToFP:
692 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
693 case Instruction::UIToFP:
694 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
695 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000696 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000697 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000698 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
699 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000700 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
701 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
702 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
703 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
704 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000705 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
706 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000707 return;
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000708 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000709 case Instruction::BitCast: {
710 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
711 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
712 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
713 return;
714 }
715 break;
716 }
717 case Instruction::ZExt: {
718 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
719 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000720 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000721
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000722 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
723 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
724 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
725 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
726 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000727 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
728 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000729 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
730 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000731 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000732 return;
733 }
734 case Instruction::SExt: {
735 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
736 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000737 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000738
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000739 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
740 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
741 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
742 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
743 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000744 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000745 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
746 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000747
748 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
749 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000750 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000751 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000752 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000753 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000754 return;
755 }
756 case Instruction::Shl:
757 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
758 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000759 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000760 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
761 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000762 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng430f6262007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000763 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
764 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000765 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000766 return;
767 }
768 break;
769 case Instruction::LShr:
770 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
771 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
772 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000773 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000774
775 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000776 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
777 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000778 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
779 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
780 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000781 // high bits known zero.
782 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000783 return;
784 }
785 break;
786 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000787 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000788 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
789 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000790 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000791
792 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000793 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
794 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000795 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
796 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
797 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
798
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000799 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
800 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000801 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000802 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000803 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000804 return;
805 }
806 break;
807 }
808}
809
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000810/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
811/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
812/// for bits that V cannot have.
813static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengedd089c2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000814 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000815 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
816 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
817 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
818}
819
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000820/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
821/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
822/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
823/// constant and return true.
824static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000825 APInt Demanded) {
826 assert(I && "No instruction?");
827 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
828
829 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
830 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
831 if (!OpC) return false;
832
833 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
834 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
835 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
836 return false;
837
838 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
839 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
840 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
841 return true;
842}
843
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000844// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
845// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
846// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
847// min/max.
848static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000849 const APInt& KnownZero,
850 const APInt& KnownOne,
851 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
852 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
853 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
854 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
855 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
856 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000857 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000858
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000859 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
860 // bit if it is unknown.
861 Min = KnownOne;
862 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
863
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000864 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000865 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
866 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000867 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000868}
869
870// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
871// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
872// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
873// min/max.
874static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000875 const APInt &KnownZero,
876 const APInt &KnownOne,
877 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
878 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000879 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
880 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
881 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
882 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000883 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000884
885 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
886 Min = KnownOne;
887 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
888 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
889}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000890
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000891/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
892/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
893/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
894/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
895/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
896/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
897/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
898/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
899/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
900/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
901/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
902/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
903/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
904/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
905/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
906bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
907 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
908 unsigned Depth) {
909 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
910 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
911 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
912 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
913 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
914 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
915 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
916 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
917 must have same BitWidth");
918 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
919 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
920 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
921 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
922 return false;
923 }
924
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000925 KnownZero.clear();
926 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000927 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
928 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
929 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
930 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
931 return false;
932 }
933 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
934 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
935 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
936 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
937 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
938 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
939 return false;
940 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
941 return false;
942 }
943
944 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
945 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
946
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000947 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
948 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
949 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
950 default: break;
951 case Instruction::And:
952 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
954 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
955 return true;
956 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
957 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
958
959 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
960 // LHS.
961 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
962 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
963 return true;
964 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
965 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
966
967 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
968 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
969 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
970 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
971 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
972 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
973 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
974 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
975
976 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
977 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
978 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
979
980 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
981 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
982 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
983
984 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
985 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
986 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
987 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
988 break;
989 case Instruction::Or:
990 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
991 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
992 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
993 return true;
994 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
995 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
996 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
997 // LHS.
998 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
999 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1000 return true;
1001 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1002 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1003
1004 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1005 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
1006 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1007 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1008 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1009 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1010 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1011 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1012
1013 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1014 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1015 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1016 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1017 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1018 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1019 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1020 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1021
1022 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1023 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1024 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1025
1026 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1027 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1028 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1029 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1030 break;
1031 case Instruction::Xor: {
1032 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1033 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1034 return true;
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1038 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1039 return true;
1040 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1041 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1042
1043 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1044 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1045 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1046 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1047 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1048 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1049
1050 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1051 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1052 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1053 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1054 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1055 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1056
1057 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1058 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1059 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1060 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1061 Instruction *Or =
1062 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1063 I->getName());
1064 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1065 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1066 }
1067
1068 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1069 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1070 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1071 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1072 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1073 // all known
1074 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1075 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1076 Instruction *And =
1077 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1078 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1079 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1080 }
1081 }
1082
1083 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1084 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1085 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1086 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1087
1088 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1089 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1090 break;
1091 }
1092 case Instruction::Select:
1093 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1094 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1095 return true;
1096 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1097 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1098 return true;
1099 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1100 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1101 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1102 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1103
1104 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1105 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1106 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1111 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1112 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1113 break;
1114 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1115 uint32_t truncBf =
1116 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001117 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1118 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1119 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1120 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1121 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001122 return true;
1123 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1124 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1125 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1126 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1127 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1128 break;
1129 }
1130 case Instruction::BitCast:
1131 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1132 return false;
1133
1134 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1135 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1136 return true;
1137 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1138 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1139 break;
1140 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1141 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1142 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001143 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001144
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001145 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1147 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1149 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 return true;
1151 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1152 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1153 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1154 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1155 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1156 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001157 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001158 break;
1159 }
1160 case Instruction::SExt: {
1161 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1162 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001163 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001166 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001167
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001168 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001169 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1170 // bit is demanded.
1171 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001172 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001173
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001174 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1175 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1176 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001177 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1178 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001179 return true;
1180 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1181 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1182 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1183 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1184 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1185
1186 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1187 // top bits of the result.
1188
1189 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1190 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001191 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001192 {
1193 // Convert to ZExt cast
1194 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1195 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001196 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001197 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001198 }
1199 break;
1200 }
1201 case Instruction::Add: {
1202 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1203 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1204 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001205 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001206
1207 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1208 // we can do.
1209 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1210 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1211 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1212 if (RHS->isZero())
1213 break;
1214
1215 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1216 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001217 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218
1219 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1220 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1221 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1222 return true;
1223
1224 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1225 // the constant.
1226 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1227 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1228
1229 // Avoid excess work.
1230 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1231 break;
1232
1233 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1234 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1235 Instruction *Or =
1236 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1237 I->getName());
1238 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1239 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1240 }
1241
1242 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1243 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1244 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1245 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1246 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1247
1248 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1249 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1250 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001251 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1252 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253
1254 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1255
1256 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1257 // other, and there is no input carry.
1258 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1259 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1260
1261 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1262 // is no input carry.
1263 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1264 } else {
1265 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1266 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001267 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1269 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001270 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001271 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1272 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1273 return true;
1274 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1275 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1276 return true;
1277 }
1278 }
1279 break;
1280 }
1281 case Instruction::Sub:
1282 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1283 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001284 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001285 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1286 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001287 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001288 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001289 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1290 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1291 return true;
1292 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1293 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1294 return true;
1295 }
1296 break;
1297 case Instruction::Shl:
1298 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001299 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001300 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1301 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001302 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1303 return true;
1304 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1305 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1306 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1307 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1308 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001309 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001310 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001311 }
1312 break;
1313 case Instruction::LShr:
1314 // For a logical shift right
1315 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001316 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001318 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001319 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1320 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001321 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1322 return true;
1323 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1324 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001325 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1326 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001327 if (ShiftAmt) {
1328 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001329 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001330 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1331 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001332 }
1333 break;
1334 case Instruction::AShr:
1335 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1336 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1337 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1338 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1339 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1340 // Perform the logical shift right.
1341 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1342 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1343 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1344 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1345 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001346
1347 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1348 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1349 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1350 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001351
1352 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001353 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001354
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001355 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001356 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001357 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1358 // demanded.
1359 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1360 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001361 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001362 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001363 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1364 return true;
1365 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1366 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1367 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001368 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001369 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1370 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1371
1372 // Handle the sign bits.
1373 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1374 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1375 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1376
1377 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1378 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001379 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001380 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1381 // Perform the logical shift right.
1382 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1383 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1384 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1385 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1386 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1387 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1388 }
1389 }
1390 break;
1391 }
1392
1393 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1394 // constant.
1395 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1396 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1397 return false;
1398}
1399
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001400
1401/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1402/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1403/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1404/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1405///
1406/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1407/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1408/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1409Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1410 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1411 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001412 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001413 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1414 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1415 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1416 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1417
1418 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1419 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1420 UndefElts = EltMask;
1421 return 0;
1422 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1423 UndefElts = EltMask;
1424 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1425 }
1426
1427 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001428 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1429 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001430 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1431
1432 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1433 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1434 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1435 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1436 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1437 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1438 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1439 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1440 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1441 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1442 }
1443
1444 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001445 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001446 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1447 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001448 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001449 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001450 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001451 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1452 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1453 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1454 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1455 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1456 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001457 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001458 }
1459
1460 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1461 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1462 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1463 return false;
1464 }
1465 return false;
1466 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1467 return false;
1468 }
1469
1470 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1471 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1472
1473 bool MadeChange = false;
1474 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1475 Value *TmpV;
1476 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1477 default: break;
1478
1479 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1480 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1481 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001482 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001483 if (Idx == 0) {
1484 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1485 // which elt is getting updated.
1486 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1487 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1488 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1489 break;
1490 }
1491
1492 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1493 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001494 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001495 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1496 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1497
1498 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1499 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1500 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1501 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1502 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1503 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1504
1505 // The inserted element is defined.
1506 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1507 break;
1508 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001509 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001510 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001511 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1512 if (!VTy) break;
1513 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1514 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1515 unsigned Ratio;
1516
1517 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001518 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001519 // elements as are demanded of us.
1520 Ratio = 1;
1521 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1522 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1523 // Untested so far.
1524 break;
1525
1526 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1527 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1528 // elements are live.
1529 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1530 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1531 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1532 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1533 }
1534 } else {
1535 // Untested so far.
1536 break;
1537
1538 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1539 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1540 // live.
1541 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1542 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1543 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1544 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1545 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001546
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001547 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1548 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1549 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1550 if (TmpV) {
1551 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1552 MadeChange = true;
1553 }
1554
1555 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1556 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1557 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1558 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1559 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1560 // undef.
1561 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1562 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1563 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1564 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1565 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1566 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1567 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1568 // elements are undef.
1569 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1570 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1571 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1572 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1573 }
1574 break;
1575 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001576 case Instruction::And:
1577 case Instruction::Or:
1578 case Instruction::Xor:
1579 case Instruction::Add:
1580 case Instruction::Sub:
1581 case Instruction::Mul:
1582 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1583 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1584 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1585 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1586 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1587 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1588 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1589
1590 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1591 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1592 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1593 break;
1594
1595 case Instruction::Call: {
1596 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1597 if (!II) break;
1598 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1599 default: break;
1600
1601 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1602 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1603 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1604 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1605 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1606 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1607 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1608 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1609 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1610 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1611 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1612 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1613 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1614 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1615 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1616 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1617
1618 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1619 // scalarize it now.
1620 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1621 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1622 default: break;
1623 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1624 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1625 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1626 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1627 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1628 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1629 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1630 // Extract the element as scalars.
1631 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1632 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1633
1634 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1635 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1637 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1638 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1639 II->getName()), *II);
1640 break;
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1642 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1643 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1644 II->getName()), *II);
1645 break;
1646 }
1647
1648 Instruction *New =
1649 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1650 II->getName());
1651 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1652 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1653 return New;
1654 }
1655 }
1656
1657 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1658 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1659 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1660 break;
1661 }
1662 break;
1663 }
1664 }
1665 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1666}
1667
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001668/// @returns true if the specified compare predicate is
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001669/// true when both operands are equal...
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001670/// @brief Determine if the icmp Predicate is true when both operands are equal
1671static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst::Predicate pred) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001672 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1673 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1674 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1675}
1676
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001677/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1678/// true when both operands are equal...
1679/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true when both operands are equal
1680static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1681 return isTrueWhenEqual(ICI.getPredicate());
1682}
1683
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001684/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1685/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1686/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1687/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1688/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1689/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1690/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1691///
1692template<typename Functor>
1693Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1694 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1695 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1696
1697 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1698 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1699 return F.apply(Root);
1700
1701 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1702 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001703 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001704 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1705 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1706
1707 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1708 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1709 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1710 ShouldApply = true;
1711 }
1712
1713 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1714 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1715 if (ShouldApply) {
1716 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001717
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001718 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1719 // and perform the reassociation.
1720 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1721
1722 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1723 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1724
1725 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1726 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001727 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001728 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1729 return 0;
1730 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001731 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001732 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001733 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1734 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1735 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1736 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001737
1738 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1739 // get to LHSI.
1740 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1741 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001742 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1743 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1744 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1745 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1746 ARI = NextLHSI;
1747
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001748 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1749 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1750 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1751 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1752 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001753
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001754 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1755 // the transformation...
1756 return F.apply(Root);
1757 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001758
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001759 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1760 }
1761 return 0;
1762}
1763
1764
1765// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1766struct AddRHS {
1767 Value *RHS;
1768 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1769 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1770 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001771 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001772 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001773 }
1774};
1775
1776// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1777// iff C1&C2 == 0
1778struct AddMaskingAnd {
1779 Constant *C2;
1780 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1781 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001782 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001783 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001784 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785 }
1786 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001787 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001788 }
1789};
1790
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001791static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001792 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001793 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001794 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001795 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001796
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001797 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1798 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001799 }
1800
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001801 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001802 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1803 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001804
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001805 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1806 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001807 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1808 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001809 }
1810
1811 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1812 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1813 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1814 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001815 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1816 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001817 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1818 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1819 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001820 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001821 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001822 abort();
1823 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001824 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1825}
1826
1827// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1828// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1829// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1830// not have a second operand.
1831static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1832 InstCombiner *IC) {
1833 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1834 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1835 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1836 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1837
1838 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001839 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001840 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001841
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001842 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1843 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1844
1845 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1846 SelectFalseVal);
1847 }
1848 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001849}
1850
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001851
1852/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1853/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1854/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1855Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1856 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001857 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001858 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001859
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001860 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1861 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001862 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001863 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1864 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1865 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1866 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001867 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001868 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1869
1870 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1871 // loop.
1872 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1873 return 0;
1874 }
1875
1876 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1877 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1878 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1879 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1880 if (NonConstBB) {
1881 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1882 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1883 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001884
1885 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001886 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001887 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001888 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001889 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001890
1891 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1892 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1893 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001894 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001895 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001896 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001897 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1898 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1899 else
1900 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001901 } else {
1902 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1903 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1904 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1905 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1906 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001907 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1908 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1909 CI->getPredicate(),
1910 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1911 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001912 else
1913 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1914
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001915 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001916 }
1917 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001918 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001919 } else {
1920 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1921 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001922 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001923 Value *InV;
1924 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001925 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001926 } else {
1927 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001928 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1929 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1930 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001931 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001932 }
1933 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001934 }
1935 }
1936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1937}
1938
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001939Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001940 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001941 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001942
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001943 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001944 // X + undef -> undef
1945 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1947
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001948 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001949 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001950 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001952 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001953 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1954 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001956 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001957
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001958 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001959 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001960 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001961 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001962 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001963 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001964
1965 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1966 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001967 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1968 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1969 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1970 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1971 return &I;
1972 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001973 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001974
1975 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1976 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1977 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001978
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001979 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1980 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001981 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1982 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001983 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001984 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001985
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001986 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001987 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1988 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001989 do {
1990 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001991 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1992 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001993 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1994 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001995 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001996 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1997 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001998 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001999 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002000 }
2001 }
2002 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002003 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2004 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2005 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002006
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002007 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
2008 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
2009 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
2010 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
2011 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2012 switch (Size) {
2013 default: break;
2014 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2015 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2016 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2017 }
2018 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002019 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002020 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002021 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002022 }
2023 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002024 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002025
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002026 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002027 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002028 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002029
2030 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2031 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2032 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2034 }
2035 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2036 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2037 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2039 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002040 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002041
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002042 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002043 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002044 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002045
2046 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002047 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2048 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002049 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002050
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002051
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002052 ConstantInt *C2;
2053 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2054 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
2055 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
2056
2057 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2058 ConstantInt *C1;
2059 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002060 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002061 }
2062
2063 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002064 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2065 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
2066
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002067 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002068 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2069 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002070
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002071
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002072 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002073 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002074 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2075 return R;
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002076
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002077 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002078 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002079 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
2080 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002081
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002082 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2083 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002084 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002085 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2086 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2087 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002088 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002089
2090 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002091 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002092
2093 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002094 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002095
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002096 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2097 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2098 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2099 LHS->getName()), I);
2100 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2101 }
2102 }
2103 }
2104
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002105 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2106 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002107 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002108 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002109 }
2110
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002111 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2112 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2113 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002114 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002115 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2116 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002117 if (!CI) {
2118 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2119 Other = LHS;
2120 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002121 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002122 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2123 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002124 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002125 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002126 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002127 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002128 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002129 }
2130 }
2131
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002132 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002133}
2134
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002135// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2136// highest order bit set.
2137static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002138 uint32_t NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer5a1e3e12007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002139 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002140}
2141
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002142Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002143 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002144
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002145 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002147
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002148 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002149 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002150 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002151
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002152 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2154 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2155 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2156
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002157 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2158 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002159 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2160 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002161
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002162 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002163 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002164 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002165 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2166
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002167 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2168 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002169 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002170 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002171 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002172 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002173 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002174 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002175 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002176 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002177 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2178 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002179 }
2180 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002181 }
2182 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2183 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2184 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002185 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002186 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002187 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002188 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002189 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002190 }
2191 }
2192 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002193 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002194
2195 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2196 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002197 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002198 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002199
2200 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2201 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2202 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002203 }
2204
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002205 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2206 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002207 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002208 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002209 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002210 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002211 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002212 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2213 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2214 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002215 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002216 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2217 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002218 }
2219
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002220 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002221 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2222 // is not used by anyone else...
2223 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002224 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002225 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002226 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2227 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2228 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2229 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002230
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002231 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002232 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002233 }
2234
2235 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2236 //
2237 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2238 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2239 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2240
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002241 Value *NewNot =
2242 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002243 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002244 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002245
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002246 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002247 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002248 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002249 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002250 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002251 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002252 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2253
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002254 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002255 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002256 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002257 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002258 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002259 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002260
2261 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2262 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2263 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2264 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2265 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2266 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
2267 return BinaryOperator::createSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
2268 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
2269 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
2270 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002271 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002272 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002273
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002274 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002275 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2276 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002277 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2278 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2279 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002281 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2282 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2283 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002284 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002285
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002286 ConstantInt *C1;
2287 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002288 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2289 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002290
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002291 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2292 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002293 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002294 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002295 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002296}
2297
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002298/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2299/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2300/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2301/// signed.
2302static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2303 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002304 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002305 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2306 TrueIfSigned = true;
2307 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002308 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2309 TrueIfSigned = true;
2310 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002311 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2312 TrueIfSigned = false;
2313 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002314 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2315 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2316 TrueIfSigned = true;
2317 return RHS->getValue() ==
2318 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2319 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2320 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2321 TrueIfSigned = true;
2322 return RHS->getValue() ==
2323 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002324 default:
2325 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002326 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002327}
2328
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002329Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002330 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002331 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002332
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002333 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2334 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2335
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002336 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002337 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2338 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002339
2340 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002341 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002342 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2343 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002344 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2345 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002346
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002347 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2349 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2351 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner0af1fab2003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002352 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002353
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002354 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002355 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002356 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002357 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002358 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002359 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002360 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002362
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002363 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2364 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002365 // We need a better interface for long double here.
2366 if (Op1->getType() == Type::FloatTy || Op1->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
2367 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002369 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002370
2371 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2372 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2373 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2374 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2375 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2376 Op1, "tmp");
2377 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2378 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2379 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2380 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2381
2382 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002383
2384 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2385 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002386 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002387 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002388
2389 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2390 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2391 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002392 }
2393
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002394 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2395 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002396 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002397
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002398 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2399 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2400 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2401 // formed.
2402 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002403 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002404 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002405 BoolCast = CI;
2406 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002407 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002408 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002409 BoolCast = CI;
2410 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002411 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002412 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2413 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002414 bool TIS = false;
2415
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002416 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002417 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2418 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002419 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2420 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002421 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002422 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002423 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002424 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002425 InsertNewInstBefore(
2426 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002427 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2428 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002429
2430 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2431 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002432 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002433 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2434 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002435 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2436 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2437 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2438 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2439 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002440
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002441 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002442 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002443 }
2444 }
2445 }
2446
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002447 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002448}
2449
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002450/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2451/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2452/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2453/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002454Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002455 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002456
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002457 // undef / X -> 0
2458 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002460
2461 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002462 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002464
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002465 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002466 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2467 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002468 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2469 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002470 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002471 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002472 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2473 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2474 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2475 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002476 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002477 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2478 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2479 else
2480 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2481 return &I;
2482 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002483
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002484 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2485 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2486 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2487 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2488 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002489 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002490 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2491 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2492 else
2493 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2494 return &I;
2495 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002496 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002497
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002498 return 0;
2499}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002500
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002501/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2502/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2503/// division instructions.
2504/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002505Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002506 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2507
2508 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2509 return Common;
2510
2511 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2512 // div X, 1 == X
2513 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2515
2516 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2517 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2518 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2519 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2520 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002521 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002522 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002523
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002524 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002525 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2526 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2527 return R;
2528 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2529 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2530 return NV;
2531 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002532 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002533
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002534 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002535 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002536 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2538
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002539 return 0;
2540}
2541
2542Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2543 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2544
2545 // Handle the integer div common cases
2546 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2547 return Common;
2548
2549 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2550 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2551 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2552 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002553 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002554 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002555 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002556 }
2557
2558 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002559 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002560 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2561 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002562 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002563 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002564 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002565 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002566 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002567 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2568 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002569 }
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002570 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002571 }
2572 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002573 }
2574
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002575 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2576 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002577 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002578 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002579 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002580 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002581 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002582 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002583 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002584 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2585 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2586 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2587 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2588 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2589
2590 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2591 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2592 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2593 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2594 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002595
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002596 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2597 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002598 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002599 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002600 return 0;
2601}
2602
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002603Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2604 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2605
2606 // Handle the integer div common cases
2607 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2608 return Common;
2609
2610 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2611 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2612 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2613 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2614
2615 // -X/C -> X/-C
2616 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2617 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2618 }
2619
2620 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2621 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002622 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002623 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002624 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2625 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2626 }
2627 }
2628
2629 return 0;
2630}
2631
2632Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2633 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2634}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002635
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002636/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2637/// of some factor, return that factor.
2638static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2639 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2640 return CI;
2641
2642 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2643 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2644
2645 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2646 if (!I) return Result;
2647
2648 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2649 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2650 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2651 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2652 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2653 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2654 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2655 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2656 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2657 }
2658 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2659 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2660 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002661 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002662 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2663 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002664 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002665 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002666 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002667 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002668 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2669 return Result;
2670 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2671 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002672 }
2673 return Result;
2674}
2675
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002676/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2677/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2678/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2679/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2680Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002681 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002682
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002683 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2684 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2685 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2686 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2687
2688 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2689 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2690 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2691 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002692
2693 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2694 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2695 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2696 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2697 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2698 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2699 // simplified also.
2700 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2701 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2702 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2703 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002704 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002705 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2706 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2707 else
2708 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002709 return &I;
2710 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002711 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2712 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2713 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2714 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2715 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002716 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002717 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2718 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2719 else
2720 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2721 return &I;
2722 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002723 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002724
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002725 return 0;
2726}
2727
2728/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2729/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2730/// remainder instructions.
2731/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2732Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2733 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2734
2735 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2736 return common;
2737
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002738 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002739 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2740 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2741 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2742
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002743 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2745
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002746 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2747 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2748 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2749 return R;
2750 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2751 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2752 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002753 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002754 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2755 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002757 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002758 }
2759
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002760 return 0;
2761}
2762
2763Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2764 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2765
2766 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2767 return common;
2768
2769 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2770 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2771 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2772 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2773 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002774 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002775 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2776 }
2777
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002778 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002779 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2780 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2781 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002782 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002783 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2784 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2785 "tmp"), I);
2786 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2787 }
2788 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002789 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002790
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002791 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2792 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2793 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2794 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2795 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2796 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002797 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2798 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002799 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2800 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2801 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2802 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2803 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2804 }
2805 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002806 }
2807
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002808 return 0;
2809}
2810
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002811Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2812 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2813
2814 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2815 return common;
2816
2817 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2818 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002819 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002820 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2821 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2822 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2823 return &I;
2824 }
2825
2826 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2827 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002828 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002829 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2830 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2831 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2832 }
2833
2834 return 0;
2835}
2836
2837Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002838 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2839}
2840
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002841// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002842static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002843 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002844 if (!isSigned)
2845 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2846 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002847}
2848
2849// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002850static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002851 if (!isSigned)
2852 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2853
2854 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2855 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2856 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002857}
2858
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002859// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2860// constant.
2861static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002862 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002863}
2864
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002865// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2866// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2867static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002868 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002869}
2870
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002871/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002872/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2873///
2874/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2875///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002876/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2877/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002878///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002879/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2880/// 0 A > B
2881/// 1 A == B
2882/// 2 A < B
2883///
2884/// <=> Value Definition
2885/// 000 0 Always false
2886/// 001 1 A > B
2887/// 010 2 A == B
2888/// 011 3 A >= B
2889/// 100 4 A < B
2890/// 101 5 A != B
2891/// 110 6 A <= B
2892/// 111 7 Always true
2893///
2894static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2895 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002896 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2905 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002907 // True -> 7
2908 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002909 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002910 return 0;
2911 }
2912}
2913
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002914/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2915/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002916/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002917/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2918static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2919 switch (code) {
2920 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002921 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002922 case 1:
2923 if (sign)
2924 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2925 else
2926 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2927 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2928 case 3:
2929 if (sign)
2930 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2931 else
2932 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2933 case 4:
2934 if (sign)
2935 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2936 else
2937 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2938 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2939 case 6:
2940 if (sign)
2941 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2942 else
2943 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002944 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002945 }
2946}
2947
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002948static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2949 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2950 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2951 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2952 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2953 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2954}
2955
2956namespace {
2957// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2958struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002959 InstCombiner &IC;
2960 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002961 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2962 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2963 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2964 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002965 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002966 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2967 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2968 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2969 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002970 return false;
2971 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002972 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2973 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2974 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2975 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2976 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002977 }
2978
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002979 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002980 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002981 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002982 unsigned Code;
2983 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2984 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2985 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2986 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002987 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002988 }
2989
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002990 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2991 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2992
2993 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002994 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2995 return I;
2996 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2997 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2998 }
2999};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003000} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003001
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003002// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3003// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003004// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003005Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003006 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3007 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003008 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3009 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003010 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003011 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003012 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003013
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003014 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3015 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003016 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003017 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003018 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003019 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003020 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003021 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003022 }
3023 break;
3024 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003025 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3026 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003027
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003028 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3029 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003030 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003031 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003032 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003033 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003034 }
3035 break;
3036 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003037 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003038 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3039 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3040 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003041 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003042
3043 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003044 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003045 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3046 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3047 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003048 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003049
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003050 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3051 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3052 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3053 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3054 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3055 // no effect.
3056 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3057 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3058 return &TheAnd;
3059 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003060 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003061 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003062 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003063 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003064 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003065 }
3066 }
3067 }
3068 }
3069 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003070
3071 case Instruction::Shl: {
3072 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3073 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3074 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003075 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003076 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003077 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3078 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003079
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003080 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3081 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003082 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3083 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003084 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3085 return &TheAnd;
3086 }
3087 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003088 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003089 case Instruction::LShr:
3090 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003091 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3092 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3093 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3094 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003095 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003096 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003097 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3098 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003099
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003100 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3101 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003102 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3103 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3104 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3105 return &TheAnd;
3106 }
3107 break;
3108 }
3109 case Instruction::AShr:
3110 // Signed shr.
3111 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3112 // with an and.
3113 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003114 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003115 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003116 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3117 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003118 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003119 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003120 // Make the argument unsigned.
3121 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003122 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003123 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003124 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003125 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003126 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003127 }
3128 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003129 }
3130 return 0;
3131}
3132
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003133
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003134/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3135/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003136/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3137/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003138/// insert new instructions.
3139Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003140 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3141 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003142 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003143 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003144 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003145
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003146 if (Inside) {
3147 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003148 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003149
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003150 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003151 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003152 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003153 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3154 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3155 }
3156
3157 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3158 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3159 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003160 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003161 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3162 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003163 }
3164
3165 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003166 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003167
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003168 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003169 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003170 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003171 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3172 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3173 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3174 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003175
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003176 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3177 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3178 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003179 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003180 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003181 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3182 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003183}
3184
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003185// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3186// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3187// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3188// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003189static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003190 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003191 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3192 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003193
3194 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003195 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003196 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003197 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003198 return true;
3199}
3200
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003201/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3202/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3203/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003204///
3205/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3206/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3207/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3208///
3209/// return (A +/- B).
3210///
3211Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003212 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003213 Instruction &I) {
3214 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3215 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3216 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3217
3218 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3219
3220 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3221 default: return 0;
3222 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003223 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003224 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003225 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3226 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3227 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003228 break;
3229
3230 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3231 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3232 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003233 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003234 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003235 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003236 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003237 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003238 break;
3239 }
3240 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003241 return 0;
3242 case Instruction::Or:
3243 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003244 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003245 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3246 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003247 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003248 break;
3249 return 0;
3250 }
3251
3252 Instruction *New;
3253 if (isSub)
3254 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3255 else
3256 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3257 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3258}
3259
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003260Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003261 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003262 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003263
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003264 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3265 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3266
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003267 // and X, X = X
3268 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003270
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003271 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003272 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003273 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003274 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3275 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3276 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003277 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003278 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003279 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003280 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003281 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003282 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003283 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003285 }
3286 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003287
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003288 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003289 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3290 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003291
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003292 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003293 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003294 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003295 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3296 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3297 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3298 case Instruction::Xor:
3299 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003300 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3301 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3302 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3303 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3304 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3305 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3306 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3307 return BinaryOperator::create(
3308 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003309 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003310 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003311 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3312 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3313 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3314 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3315 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3316 return BinaryOperator::create(
3317 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3318 }
3319 }
3320
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003321 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003322 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003323 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3324 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3325 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3326 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3327 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3328 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3329 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003330 break;
3331
3332 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003333 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3334 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3335 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3336 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3337 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003338 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003339 }
3340
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003341 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003342 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003343 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003344 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003345 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3346 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3347 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3348 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003349 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003350 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner7560c3a2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003351 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003352 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3353 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003354 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3355 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3356 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003357 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3358 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3359 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003360 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003361 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003362 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003363 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003364 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3365 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3366 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3367 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003368 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003369 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3371 }
3372 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003373 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003374
3375 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3376 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003377 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003378 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003379 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3380 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3381 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003382 }
3383
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003384 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3385 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003386
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003387 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3388 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3389
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003390 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003391 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003392 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3393 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003394 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003395 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3396 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003397
3398 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003399 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3400 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003401 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003403
3404 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3405 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3406 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3407 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3408 }
3409 }
3410
3411 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003412 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3413 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003414
3415 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3416 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3417 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3418 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3419 }
3420 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003421
3422 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3423 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3424 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3425 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3426 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3427 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3428 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3429 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3430 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3431 }
3432 }
3433 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3434 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3435 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3436 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3437 std::swap(A, B);
3438 }
3439 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3440 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3441 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3442 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3443 }
3444 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003445 }
3446
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003447 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3448 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3449 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003450 return R;
3451
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003452 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3453 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003454 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3455 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3456 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3457 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3458 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3459 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3460 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3461 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3462 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003463 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003464 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3465 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3466 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3467 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003468 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003469 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3470 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3471 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3472 }
3473
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003474 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003475 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3476 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003477 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3478 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3479 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003480 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3481
3482 switch (LHSCC) {
3483 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003484 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003485 switch (RHSCC) {
3486 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003487 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3488 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3489 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003490 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003491 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3492 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3493 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003494 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3495 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003496 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003497 switch (RHSCC) {
3498 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003499 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3500 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3501 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3502 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3503 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3504 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3505 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3506 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3507 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3509 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003510 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3512 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003513 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3514 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3515 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3516 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003517 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3518 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003519 }
3520 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3521 }
3522 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003524 switch (RHSCC) {
3525 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3527 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003529 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3530 break;
3531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3532 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003534 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3535 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003536 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003537 break;
3538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003539 switch (RHSCC) {
3540 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003541 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3542 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003543 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003544 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3545 break;
3546 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3547 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003548 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003549 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3550 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003551 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003552 break;
3553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3554 switch (RHSCC) {
3555 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3556 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3557 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3561 break;
3562 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3563 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3564 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3565 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3567 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3568 true, I);
3569 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3570 break;
3571 }
3572 break;
3573 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3574 switch (RHSCC) {
3575 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3576 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3578 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3581 break;
3582 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3583 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3584 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3585 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3586 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3587 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3588 true, I);
3589 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3590 break;
3591 }
3592 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003593 }
3594 }
3595 }
3596
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003597 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003598 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3599 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3600 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3601 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003602 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003603 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003604 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3605 I.getType(), TD) &&
3606 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3607 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003608 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3609 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3610 I.getName());
3611 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3612 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3613 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003614 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003615
3616 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003617 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3618 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3619 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003620 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3621 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3622 Instruction *NewOp =
3623 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3624 SI1->getOperand(0),
3625 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003626 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3627 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003628 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003629 }
3630
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003631 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003632}
3633
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003634/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3635/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3636/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003637static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003638 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3639 if (I == 0) return true;
3640
3641 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3642 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3643 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3644 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3645
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003646 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003647 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3648 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003649 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003650 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003651 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003652 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3653 return true;
3654
3655 unsigned DestNo;
3656 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3657 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3658 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3659 } else {
3660 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3661 DestNo = 0;
3662 }
3663
3664 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3665 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3666 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3667 return true;
3668 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3669 return false;
3670 }
3671
3672 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3673 // don't have this.
3674 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3675 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3676 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3677 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3678 return true;
3679 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3680
3681 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003682 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3683 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003684 return true;
3685
3686 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3687 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003688 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3689 return true;
3690 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003691 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003692 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003693 break;
3694 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3695 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3696
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003697 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003698 unsigned SrcByte;
3699 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3700 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3701 else
3702 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3703
3704 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3705 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3706 return true;
3707
3708 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3709 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3710 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3711 return true;
3712 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3713 return false;
3714}
3715
3716/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3717/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3718Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003719 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3720 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3721 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003722
3723 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3724 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003725 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003726 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003727
3728 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3729 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3730 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3731 return 0;
3732
3733 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3734 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3735 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3736
3737 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3738 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3739 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3740 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003741 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003742 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003743 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003744 return new CallInst(F, V);
3745}
3746
3747
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003748Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003749 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003750 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003751
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003752 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003754
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003755 // or X, X = X
3756 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003758
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003759 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3760 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003761 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3762 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3763 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3764 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3765 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3766 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003767 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3769 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3770 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3771 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003772 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003773
3774
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003775
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003776 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003777 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003778 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003779 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3780 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003781 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003782 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003783 Or->takeName(Op0);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003784 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or,
3785 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003786 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003787
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003788 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3789 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003790 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003791 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003792 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003793 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003794 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003795 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003796
3797 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3798 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003799 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003800 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003801 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3802 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3803 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003804 }
3805
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003806 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3807 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003808
3809 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3810 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3812 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3813 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3814 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3815
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003816 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3817 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003818 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003819 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3820 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3821 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003822 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3823 return BSwap;
3824 }
3825
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003826 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3827 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003828 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003829 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3830 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3831 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3832 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003833 }
3834
3835 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3836 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003837 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003838 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3839 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3840 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3841 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003842 }
3843
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003844 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00003845 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003846 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
3847 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003848 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
3849 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
3850 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
3851 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
3852 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3853 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3854 // replace with V+N.
3855 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
3856 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
3857 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3858 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3859 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
3860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3861 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
3862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3863 }
3864 // Or commutes, try both ways.
3865 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
3866 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3867 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3868 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
3869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3870 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
3871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3872 }
3873 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003874 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003875 }
3876
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003877 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
3878 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003879 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3880 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
3881 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
3882 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
3883 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
3884 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
3885 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
3886 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
3887 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
3888
3889 if (V1) {
3890 Value *Or =
3891 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
3892 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003893 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003894 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003895 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003896
3897 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003898 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3899 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3900 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003901 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3902 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3903 Instruction *NewOp =
3904 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3905 SI1->getOperand(0),
3906 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003907 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3908 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003909 }
3910 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003911
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003912 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3913 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003914 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003915 } else {
3916 A = 0;
3917 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003918 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003919 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3920 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003921 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003922
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003923 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003924 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3925 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3926 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3927 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3928 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003929 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003930
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003931 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3932 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3933 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003934 return R;
3935
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003936 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3937 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003938 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3939 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3940 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3941 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3942 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3943 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3944 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3945 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003946 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3947 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
3948 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003949 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003950 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003951 bool NeedsSwap;
3952 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003953 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003954 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003955 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003956
3957 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003958 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3959 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3960 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3961 }
3962
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003963 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003964 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3965 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003966 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3967 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003968 // equal.
3969 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3970
3971 switch (LHSCC) {
3972 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003973 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003974 switch (RHSCC) {
3975 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003976 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003977 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3978 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3979 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3980 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3981 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003982 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003983 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003984 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003985 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3986 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
3987 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00003988 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003989 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
3991 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3993 }
3994 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003995 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003996 switch (RHSCC) {
3997 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003998 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
3999 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4000 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004002 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4003 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4004 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004006 }
4007 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004008 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004009 switch (RHSCC) {
4010 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004011 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004012 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004013 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
4014 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4015 false, I);
4016 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4017 break;
4018 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4019 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004020 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004021 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4022 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004023 }
4024 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004025 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004026 switch (RHSCC) {
4027 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004028 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4029 break;
4030 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
4031 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4032 false, I);
4033 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4034 break;
4035 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4036 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4037 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4038 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4039 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004040 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004041 break;
4042 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4043 switch (RHSCC) {
4044 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4045 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4046 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4047 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4048 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4049 break;
4050 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4051 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004052 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004053 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4054 break;
4055 }
4056 break;
4057 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4058 switch (RHSCC) {
4059 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4060 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4061 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4062 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4063 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4064 break;
4065 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4066 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004068 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4069 break;
4070 }
4071 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004072 }
4073 }
4074 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004075
4076 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004077 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004078 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004079 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
4080 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004081 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004082 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004083 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4084 I.getType(), TD) &&
4085 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4086 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004087 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4088 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4089 I.getName());
4090 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4091 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4092 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004093 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004094
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004095
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004096 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004097}
4098
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004099// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4100struct XorSelf {
4101 Value *RHS;
4102 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4103 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4104 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4105 return &Xor;
4106 }
4107};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004108
4109
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004110Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004111 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004112 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004113
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004114 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
4115 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
4116
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004117 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4118 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004119 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004120 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004121 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004122
4123 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4124 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004125 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4126 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4127 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4128 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4129 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4130 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004131 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4132 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004133 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004134
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004135 // Is this a ~ operation?
4136 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4137 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4138 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4139 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4140 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4141 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4142 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4143 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4144 Instruction *NotY =
4145 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
4146 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4147 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4148 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
4149 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4150 else
4151 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4152 }
4153 }
4154 }
4155 }
4156
4157
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004158 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004159 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4160 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4161 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004162 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4163 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004164
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004165 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4166 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4167 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4168 }
4169
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004170 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004171 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004172 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4173 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004174 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4175 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004176 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004177 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004178 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004179
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004180 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004181 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004182 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004183 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004184 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4185 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4186 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004187 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004188 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004189 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004190 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4191 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
4192 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004193
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004194 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004195 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4196 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004197 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004198 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4199 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4200 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004201 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004202 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4203 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004204 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004205 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4206 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4207 return &I;
4208 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004209 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004210 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004211
4212 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4213 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004214 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004215 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004216 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4217 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4218 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004219 }
4220
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004221 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004222 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004223 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004224
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004225 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004226 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004228
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004229
4230 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4231 if (Op1I) {
4232 Value *A, *B;
4233 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4234 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004235 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004236 I.swapOperands();
4237 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004238 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004239 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004240 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004241 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004242 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4243 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4245 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4246 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4247 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004248 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004249 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004250 std::swap(A, B);
4251 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004252 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004253 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4254 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4255 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004256 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004257 }
4258
4259 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4260 if (Op0I) {
4261 Value *A, *B;
4262 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4263 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4264 std::swap(A, B);
4265 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4266 Instruction *NotB =
4267 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4268 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004269 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004270 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4271 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4272 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4273 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4275 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4276 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4277 std::swap(A, B);
4278 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004279 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004280 Instruction *N =
4281 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004282 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4283 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004284 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004285 }
4286
4287 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4288 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4289 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4290 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4291 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4292 Instruction *NewOp =
4293 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4294 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4295 Op0I->getName()), I);
4296 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4297 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4298 }
4299
4300 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4301 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4302 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4303 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4304 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4305 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4306 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4307 }
4308 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4309 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4310 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4311 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4312 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4313 }
4314
4315 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4316 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4317 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4318 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4319 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4320 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4321 if (A == C)
4322 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4323 else if (A == D)
4324 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4325 else if (B == C)
4326 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4327 else if (B == D)
4328 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4329
4330 if (X) {
4331 Instruction *NewOp =
4332 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4333 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4334 }
4335 }
4336 }
4337
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004338 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4339 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4340 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004341 return R;
4342
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004343 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004344 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004345 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004346 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4347 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004348 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004349 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004350 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4351 I.getType(), TD) &&
4352 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4353 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004354 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4355 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4356 I.getName());
4357 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4358 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4359 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004360 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004361
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004362 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004363}
4364
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004365/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4366/// overflowed for this type.
4367static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004368 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004369 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004370
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004371 if (IsSigned)
4372 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4373 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4374 else
4375 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4376 else
4377 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004378}
4379
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004380/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4381/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4382/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4383static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4384 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4385 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004386 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4387 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004388
4389 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004390 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSize()*8;
4391 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004392
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004393 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4394 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattner0b84c802005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004395 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004396 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4397 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4398
4399 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4400 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4401 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4402
4403 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4404 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004405 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004406 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4407 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result,
4408 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4409 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4410 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004411 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004412
4413 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4414 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4415 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4416 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4417 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4418 else {
4419 // Emit an add instruction.
4420 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4421 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4422 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004423 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004424 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004425 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004426 // Convert to correct type.
4427 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4428 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4429 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4430 else
4431 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4432 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4433 }
4434 if (Size != 1) {
4435 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4436 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4437 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4438 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4439 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4440 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4441 }
4442
4443 // Emit an add instruction.
4444 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4445 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4446 cast<Constant>(Result));
4447 else
4448 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
4449 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004450 }
4451 return Result;
4452}
4453
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004454/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004455/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004456Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4457 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4458 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004459 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004460
4461 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4462 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4463 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4464
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004465 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4466 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4467 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004468 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4469 // each index is zero or not.
4470 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004471 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004472 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4473 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004474 bool EmitIt = true;
4475 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4476 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4477 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4478 if (C->isNullValue())
4479 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004480 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4481 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004482 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004483 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004484 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4485 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004486 }
4487
4488 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004489 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004490 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004491 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4492 if (InVal == 0)
4493 InVal = Comp;
4494 else {
4495 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4496 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004497 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004498 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4499 else // True if all are equal
4500 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4501 }
4502 }
4503 }
4504
4505 if (InVal)
4506 return InVal;
4507 else
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004508 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004509 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4510 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004511 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004512
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004513 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004514 // the result to fold to a constant!
4515 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4516 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4517 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004518 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4519 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004520 }
4521 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004522 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4523 // compare the base pointer.
4524 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4525 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004526 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004527 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004528 if (IndicesTheSame)
4529 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4530 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4531 IndicesTheSame = false;
4532 break;
4533 }
4534
4535 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4536 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004537 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4538 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004539
4540 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4541 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004542 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004543 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004544
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004545 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4546 bool AllZeros = true;
4547 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4548 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4549 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4550 AllZeros = false;
4551 break;
4552 }
4553 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004554 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4555 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004556
4557 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004558 AllZeros = true;
4559 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4560 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4561 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4562 AllZeros = false;
4563 break;
4564 }
4565 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004566 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004567
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004568 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4569 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4570 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4571 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4572 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4573 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004574 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4575 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004576 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004577 NumDifferences = 2;
4578 break;
4579 } else {
4580 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4581 DiffOperand = i;
4582 }
4583 }
4584
4585 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004587 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4588 isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
4589
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004590 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004591 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4592 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004593 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4594 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004595 }
4596 }
4597
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004598 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004599 // the result to fold to a constant!
4600 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4601 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4602 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4603 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4604 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004605 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004606 }
4607 }
4608 return 0;
4609}
4610
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004611Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4612 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004613 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004614
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004615 // Fold trivial predicates.
4616 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4617 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4618 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4619 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4620
4621 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4622 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4623 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4624 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4625 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4626 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4627 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4628 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4629 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4630 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4631 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4633
4634 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4635 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4636 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4637 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4638 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4639 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4640 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4641 return &I;
4642
4643 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4644 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4645 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4646 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4647 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4648 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4649 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4650 return &I;
4651 }
4652 }
4653
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004654 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004655 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004656
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004657 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4658 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4659 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4660 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4661 case Instruction::PHI:
4662 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4663 return NV;
4664 break;
4665 case Instruction::Select:
4666 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4667 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4668 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4669 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4670 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4671 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4672 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4673 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4674 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4675 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4676 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4677 I.getName()), I);
4678 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4679 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4680 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4681 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4682 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4683 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4684 I.getName()), I);
4685 }
4686 }
4687
4688 if (Op1)
4689 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4690 break;
4691 }
4692 }
4693
4694 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4695}
4696
4697Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4698 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4699 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4700 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4701
4702 // icmp X, X
4703 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004704 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4705 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004706
4707 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004708 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004709
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004710 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004711 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004712 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4713 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4714 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004715 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004716 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4717 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004718
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004719 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004720 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004721 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4722 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4723 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004724 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004725 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004726 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004727 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004728 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004729 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004730
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004731 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4732 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4733 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004734 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004735 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4736 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004737 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4738 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4739 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4740 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004741 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4742 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4743 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004744 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004745 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004747 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4748 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4749 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4750 }
4751 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004752 }
4753
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004754 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4755 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004756 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004757 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4758 default: break;
4759 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4760 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004761 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004762 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4763 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4764 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4765 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004766 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
4767 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
4768 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
4769 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
4770
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004771 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004772
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004773 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4774 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004775 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004776 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4777 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4778 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4779 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4780 break;
4781
4782 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4783 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004784 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004785 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4786 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4787 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4788 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004789
4790 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
4791 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
4792 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
4793 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004794 break;
4795
4796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4797 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004798 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004799 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4800 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4801 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4802 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4803 break;
4804
4805 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4806 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004808 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4809 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4810 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4811 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4812 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004813
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004814 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4815 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004817 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4818 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4819 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4820 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4821 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004822
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004823 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4824 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004826 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4827 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4828 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4829 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4830 break;
4831
4832 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4833 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004835 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4836 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4837 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4838 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4839 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004840 }
4841
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004842 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4843 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004844 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4845 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004846 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004847 default: break;
4848 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4849 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4850 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4851 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4852 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4853 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4854 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4855 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004856 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004857
4858 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004859 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
4860 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
4861
4862 bool UnusedBit;
4863 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
4864
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004865 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4866 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004867 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
4868 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
4869 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004870 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4871 return &I;
4872
4873 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4874 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004875 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004876 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4877 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004878 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
4879 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004880 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004881 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4882 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004883 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004884 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4885 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004886 }
4887 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4888 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4889 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004890 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004892 break;
4893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004894 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004896 break;
4897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004898 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004899 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004900 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004901 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004902 break;
4903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004904 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004905 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004906 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004907 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004908 break;
4909 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004910 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004912 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004914 break;
4915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004916 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004917 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004918 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004920 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004921 }
4922 }
4923
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004924 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004925 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004926 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004927 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004928 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
4929 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004930 }
4931
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004932 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004933 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4934 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4935 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004936 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4937 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004938 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004939 bool isAllZeros = true;
4940 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4941 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
4942 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4943 isAllZeros = false;
4944 break;
4945 }
4946 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004947 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004948 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
4949 }
4950 break;
4951
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004952 case Instruction::PHI:
4953 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4954 return NV;
4955 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004956 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004957 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4958 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4959 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4960 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4961 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4962 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4963 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004964 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4965 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4966 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4967 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4968 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004969 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4970 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004971 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4972 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4973 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4974 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4975 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004976 }
4977 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00004978
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004979 if (Op1)
4980 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4981 break;
4982 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004983 case Instruction::Malloc:
4984 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
4985 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
4986 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
4987 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
4988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4989 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
4990 }
4991 break;
4992 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004993 }
4994
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004995 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004996 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004997 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004998 return NI;
4999 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005000 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5001 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005002 return NI;
5003
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005004 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005005 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5006 // now.
5007 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5008 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5009 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005010 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5011 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005012 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005013
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005014 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5015 // so eliminate it as well.
5016 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5017 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005018
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005019 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005020 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005021 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005022 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005023 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005024 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005025 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005026 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005027 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005028 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005029 }
5030
5031 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005032 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005033 // This comes up when you have code like
5034 // int X = A < B;
5035 // if (X) ...
5036 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005037 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5038 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005039 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005040 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005041 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005042
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005043 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005044 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5045 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5046 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5047 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5048 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5049 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5050 }
5051
5052 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5053 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5054 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5055 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5056 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005057 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005058 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5059 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5060 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5061 }
5062
5063 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5064 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5065 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5066 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5067 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5068 }
5069 }
5070
5071 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5072 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005073 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5074 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005075 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5076 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005077 }
5078 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005079 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005080 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5081 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005082 }
5083 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005084 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005085 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5086 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005087 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005088
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005089 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5090 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5091 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5092 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5093 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5094
5095 if (A == C) {
5096 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5097 } else if (A == D) {
5098 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5099 } else if (B == C) {
5100 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5101 } else if (B == D) {
5102 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5103 }
5104
5105 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5106 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5107 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5108 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5109 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5110 return &I;
5111 }
5112 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005113 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005114 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005115}
5116
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005117
5118/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5119/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5120Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5121 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5122 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5123 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5124
5125 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5126 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5127 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5128 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5129 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5130 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5131 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5132 // if it finds it.
5133 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5134 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5135 return 0;
5136 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005137 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005138
5139 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5140 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5141 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5142 // instead of computing a divide.
5143 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5144
5145 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5146 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5147 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5148 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5149 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5150
5151 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005152 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005153
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005154 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5155 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5156 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5157 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5158 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5159 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5160 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5161 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5162 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5163
5164
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005165 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005166 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005167 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005168 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5169 if (!HiOverflow)
5170 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005171 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
5172 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005173 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005174 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5175 HiBound = DivRHS;
5176 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005177 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5178 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5179 if (!HiOverflow)
5180 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005181 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005182 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005183 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5184 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005185 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005186 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005187 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005188 }
5189 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
5190 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005191 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005192 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5193 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005194 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5195 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5196 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5197 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005198 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005199 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5200 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005201 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005202 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005203 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5204 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005205 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005206 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005207 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005208 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5209 }
5210
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005211 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5212 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005213 }
5214
5215 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005216 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005217 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5218 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5219 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5221 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005222 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005223 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5224 else if (LoOverflow)
5225 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5226 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5227 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005228 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005229 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5230 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5232 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005233 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005234 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5235 else if (LoOverflow)
5236 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5237 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5238 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005239 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005240 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5241 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005242 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5243 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5244 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005246 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005247 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5248 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005249 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005251 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5253 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005254 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5255 else
5256 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5257 }
5258}
5259
5260
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005261/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5262///
5263Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5264 Instruction *LHSI,
5265 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5266 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5267
5268 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005269 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005270 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5271 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5272 // fold the xor.
5273 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0 ||
5274 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue()) {
5275 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5276
5277 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5278 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5279 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5280 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5281 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5282 return &ICI;
5283 }
5284
5285 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5286 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5287
5288 // If so, the new one isn't.
5289 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5290
5291 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5292 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5293 else
5294 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5295 }
5296 }
5297 break;
5298 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5299 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5300 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5301 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5302
5303 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5304 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5305 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5306 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5307 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5308 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5309 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5310 // bit would not work.
5311 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
5312 (ICI.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
5313 RHSV.isPositive())) {
5314 uint32_t BitWidth =
5315 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5316 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5317 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5318 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5319 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5320 Instruction *NewAnd =
5321 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
5322 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5323 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5324 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5325 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5326 }
5327 }
5328
5329 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5330 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5331 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5332 // access.
5333 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5334 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5335 Shift = 0;
5336
5337 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5338 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5339 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5340 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5341
5342 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5343 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5344 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5345 if (ShAmt) {
5346 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5347 if (!CanFold) {
5348 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5349 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5350 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5351 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5352
5353 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5354 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5355 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5356 CanFold = true;
5357 }
5358
5359 if (CanFold) {
5360 Constant *NewCst;
5361 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5362 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5363 else
5364 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5365
5366 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5367 // compared.
5368 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5369 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5370 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5371 // result is always true or false now.
5372 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5374 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5376 } else {
5377 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5378 Constant *NewAndCST;
5379 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5380 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5381 else
5382 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5383 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5384 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5385 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5386 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5387 return &ICI;
5388 }
5389 }
5390 }
5391
5392 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5393 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5394 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5395 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5396 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5397 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5398 // Compute C << Y.
5399 Value *NS;
5400 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5401 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
5402 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5403 } else {
5404 // Insert a logical shift.
5405 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
5406 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5407 }
5408 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5409
5410 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5411 Instruction *NewAnd =
5412 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
5413 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5414
5415 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5416 return &ICI;
5417 }
5418 }
5419 break;
5420
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005421 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5422 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5423 if (!ShAmt) break;
5424
5425 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5426
5427 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5428 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5429 // simplified.
5430 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5431 break;
5432
5433 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5434 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5435 // comparison cannot succeed.
5436 Constant *Comp =
5437 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5438 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5439 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5440 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5441 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5442 }
5443
5444 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5445 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5446 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5447 Constant *Mask =
5448 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005449
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005450 Instruction *AndI =
5451 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5452 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5453 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5454 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5455 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005456 }
5457 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005458
5459 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5460 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5461 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5462 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5463 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5464 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5465 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5466 Instruction *AndI =
5467 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5468 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5469 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5470
5471 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5472 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5473 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005474 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005475 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005476
5477 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005478 case Instruction::AShr: {
5479 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5480 if (!ShAmt) break;
5481
5482 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5483 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5484 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5485 // simplified.
5486 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5487 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5488 break;
5489 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5490
5491 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5492 // comparison cannot succeed.
5493 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5494 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5495 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5496 else
5497 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5498
5499 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5500 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5501 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5502 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5503 }
5504
5505 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || RHSV == 0) {
5506 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5507 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5508 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005509
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005510 Instruction *AndI =
5511 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5512 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5513 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5514 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5515 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005516 }
5517 }
5518 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005519 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005520
5521 case Instruction::SDiv:
5522 case Instruction::UDiv:
5523 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5524 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5525 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5526 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5527 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5528 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005529 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
5530 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
5531 DivRHS))
5532 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005533 break;
5534 }
5535
5536 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
5537 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5538 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5539
5540 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5541 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
5542 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
5543 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
5544 case Instruction::SRem:
5545 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
5546 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
5547 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
5548 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
5549 Instruction *NewRem =
5550 BinaryOperator::createURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
5551 BO->getName());
5552 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
5553 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5554 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
5555 }
5556 }
5557 break;
5558 case Instruction::Add:
5559 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5560 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5561 if (BO->hasOneUse())
5562 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5563 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
5564 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
5565 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5566 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5567 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
5568
5569 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
5570 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
5571 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
5572 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
5573 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
5574 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
5575 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
5576 Neg->takeName(BO);
5577 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
5578 }
5579 }
5580 break;
5581 case Instruction::Xor:
5582 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5583 // the explicit xor.
5584 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5585 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5586 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
5587
5588 // FALLTHROUGH
5589 case Instruction::Sub:
5590 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
5591 if (RHSV == 0)
5592 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5593 BO->getOperand(1));
5594 break;
5595
5596 case Instruction::Or:
5597 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5598 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
5599 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5600 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
5601 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
5602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5603 isICMP_NE));
5604 }
5605 break;
5606
5607 case Instruction::And:
5608 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5609 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5610 // comparison can never succeed!
5611 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
5612 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5613 isICMP_NE));
5614
5615 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
5616 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
5617 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5618 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
5619 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
5620
5621 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
5622 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5623 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5624 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5625 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5626 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5627 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
5628 }
5629
5630 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
5631 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5632 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5633 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
5634 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5635 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5636 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
5637 }
5638 }
5639 default: break;
5640 }
5641 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
5642 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5643 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5644 AddToWorkList(II);
5645 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
5646 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
5647 return &ICI;
5648 }
5649 }
5650 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00005651 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
5652 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005653 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
5654 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5655 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
5656 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5657 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
5658 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5659 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5660 // smaller constant values.
5661 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
5662 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5663 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5664 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
5665 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
5666 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
5667 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5668 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5669 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5670 }
5671 }
5672 }
5673 }
5674 return 0;
5675}
5676
5677/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
5678/// We only handle extending casts so far.
5679///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005680Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5681 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005682 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5683 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005684 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005685 Value *RHSCIOp;
5686
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005687 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
5688 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
5689 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
5690 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
5691 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
5692 Value *RHSOp = 0;
5693 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00005694 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005695 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
5696 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
5697 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
5698 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
5699 RHSOp = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, RHSOp,
5700 LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
5701 }
5702
5703 if (RHSOp)
5704 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
5705 }
5706
5707 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
5708 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005709 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5710 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005711 return 0;
5712
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005713 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5714 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005715
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005716 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005717 // Not an extension from the same type?
5718 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005719 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5720 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005721
5722 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5723 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5724 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5725 return 0;
5726
5727 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5728 // then we can't handle this.
5729 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5730 return 0;
5731
5732 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5733 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005734 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005735
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005736 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5737 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5738 if (!CI)
5739 return 0;
5740
5741 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5742 // reextended to DestTy.
5743 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5744 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5745
5746 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5747 if (Res2 == CI) {
5748 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5749 // For example, we might have:
5750 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5751 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5752 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5753 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5754 // because %A may have negative value.
5755 //
5756 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5757 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005758 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005759 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5760 else
5761 return 0;
5762 }
5763
5764 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5765 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5766
5767 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5768 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5769 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005770 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005771 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005773
5774 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5775 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5776 Value *Result;
5777 if (isSignedCmp) {
5778 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005779 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005780 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005781 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005782 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005783 } else {
5784 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5785 if (isSignedExt) {
5786 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5787 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005788 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005789 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5790 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5791 } else {
5792 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005793 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005794 }
5795 }
5796
5797 // Finally, return the value computed.
5798 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5799 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5800 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5801 } else {
5802 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5803 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5804 "ICmp should be folded!");
5805 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5807 else
5808 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5809 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005810}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005811
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005812Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5813 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5814}
5815
5816Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5817 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5818}
5819
5820Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5821 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5822}
5823
5824Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5825 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005826 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005827
5828 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5829 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005830 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005831 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005833
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005834 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5835 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005836 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005837 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5839 }
5840 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005841 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5842 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5843 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005845 }
5846
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005847 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5848 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005849 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005850 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005851 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5852
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005853 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5854 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5855 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005856 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005857 return R;
5858
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005859 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005860 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005861 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5862 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005863 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005864 }
5865 }
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005866
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005867 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005868 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5869 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005870 return 0;
5871}
5872
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005873Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005874 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005875 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005876
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005877 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5878 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005879 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5880 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5881 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005882 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5883 return &I;
5884
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005885 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5886 // of a signed value.
5887 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005888 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005889 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005890 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5891 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005892 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005893 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005894 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005895 }
5896
5897 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5898 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5899 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5900 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5901 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5902 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5903
5904 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5905 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5906 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5907 return R;
5908 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5909 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5910 return NV;
5911
5912 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005913 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5914 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5915 Value *V1, *V2;
5916 ConstantInt *CC;
5917 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005918 default: break;
5919 case Instruction::Add:
5920 case Instruction::And:
5921 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005922 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005923 // These operators commute.
5924 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005925 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5926 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005927 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005928 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005929 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005930 Op0BO->getName());
5931 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005932 Instruction *X =
5933 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5934 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005935 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005936 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005937 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5938 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005939 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005940
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005941 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005942 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005943 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005944 match(Op0BOOp1,
5945 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005946 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5947 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005948 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005949 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5950 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005951 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5952 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005953 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005954 V1->getName()+".mask");
5955 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5956
5957 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5958 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005959 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005960
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005961 // FALL THROUGH.
5962 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005963 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005964 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5965 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005966 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005967 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005968 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5969 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005970 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005971 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005972 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005973 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005974 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005975 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005976 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5977 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005978 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005979
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005980 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005981 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5982 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5983 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005984 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005985 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
5986 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005987 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005988 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5989 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005990 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5991 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005992 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005993 V1->getName()+".mask");
5994 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5995
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005996 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005997 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005998
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005999 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006000 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006001 }
6002
6003
6004 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6005 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6006 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6007 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6008 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6009
6010 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006011 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006012 case Instruction::Add:
6013 isValid = isLeftShift;
6014 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006015 case Instruction::Or:
6016 case Instruction::Xor:
6017 highBitSet = false;
6018 break;
6019 case Instruction::And:
6020 highBitSet = true;
6021 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006022 }
6023
6024 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6025 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6026 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6027 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6028 // operation.
6029 //
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006030 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006031 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006032 }
6033
6034 if (isValid) {
6035 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6036
6037 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006038 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006039 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006040 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006041
6042 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
6043 NewRHS);
6044 }
6045 }
6046 }
6047 }
6048
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006049 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006050 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6051 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6052 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006053
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006054 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006055 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006056 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6057 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006058 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6059 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6060 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006061
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006062 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006063 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6064 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006065
6066 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6067
6068 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006069 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006070 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
6071 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6072 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6073 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6074 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
6075 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6076 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6077 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6078 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6079 Instruction *Shift =
6080 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6081 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6082
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006083 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006084 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006085 }
6086
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006087 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6088 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6089 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6090 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6091 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006092 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006093 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006094 }
6095 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6096 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006097 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006098 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006099 }
6100 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6101 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6102 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6103 // generators.
6104 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6105 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006106 case 1 :
6107 case 8 :
6108 case 16 :
6109 case 32 :
6110 case 64 :
6111 case 128:
6112 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6113 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006114 default: break;
6115 }
6116 if (SExtType) {
6117 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6118 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6119 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6120 }
6121 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6122 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006123 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006124
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006125 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006126 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6127 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6128 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006129 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006130 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006131 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6132
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006133 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
6134 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006135 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006136
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006137 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006138 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6139 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6140 Instruction *Shift =
6141 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6142 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006143
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006144 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006145 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006146 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006147
6148 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6149 } else {
6150 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006151 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006152
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006153 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006154 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6155 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6156 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6157 Instruction *Shift =
6158 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
6159 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6160 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6161
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006162 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006163 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006164 }
6165
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006166 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006167 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6168 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6169 Instruction *Shift =
6170 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6171 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6172
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006173 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006174 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006175 }
6176
6177 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006178 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006179 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006180 return 0;
6181}
6182
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006183
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006184/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6185/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6186/// X*Scale+Offset.
6187///
6188static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006189 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006190 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006191 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006192 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
6193 Scale = 1;
6194 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006195 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
6196 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006197 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006198 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6199 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6200 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
6201 Offset = 0;
6202 return I->getOperand(0);
6203 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6204 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
6205 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
6206 Offset = 0;
6207 return I->getOperand(0);
6208 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6209 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6210 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6211 unsigned SubScale;
6212 Value *SubVal =
6213 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6214 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
6215 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
6216 Scale = SubScale;
6217 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006218 }
6219 }
6220 }
6221 }
6222 }
6223
6224 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6225 Scale = 1;
6226 Offset = 0;
6227 return Val;
6228}
6229
6230
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006231/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6232/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006233Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006234 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006235 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006236
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006237 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6238 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006239
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006240 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6241 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6242 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6243 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6244 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6245
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006246 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006247 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006248 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006249 }
6250 }
6251
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006252 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6253 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6254 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6255 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006256
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006257 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6258 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006259 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6260
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006261 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6262 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6263 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6264 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6265
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006266 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
6267 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006268 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006269
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006270 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6271 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006272 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6273 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006274 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6275 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6276
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006277 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6278 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006279 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6280 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006281
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006282 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6283 Value *Amt = 0;
6284 if (Scale == 1) {
6285 Amt = NumElements;
6286 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006287 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006288 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6289 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006290 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006291 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006292 else if (Scale != 1) {
6293 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6294 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006295 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006296 }
6297
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006298 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6299 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006300 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6301 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6302 }
6303
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006304 AllocationInst *New;
6305 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006306 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006307 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006308 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006309 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006310 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006311
6312 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6313 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6314 // die soon.
6315 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6316 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006317 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6318 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6319 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006320 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6321 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6322 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6324}
6325
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006326/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006327/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6328/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6329/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6330/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6331///
6332/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6333/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6334static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006335 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006336 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6337 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6338 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006339
6340 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006341 if (!I) return false;
6342
6343 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006344
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006345 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6346 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6347 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6348 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6349 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6350 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6351 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6352 // casts first.
6353 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
6354 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6355 return true;
6356 }
6357 }
6358
6359 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6360 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6361 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6362
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006363 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006364 case Instruction::Add:
6365 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006366 case Instruction::And:
6367 case Instruction::Or:
6368 case Instruction::Xor:
6369 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006370 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6371 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6372 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6373 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006374
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006375 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006376 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6377 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6378 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006379 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6380 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6381 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006382 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6383 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006384 }
6385 break;
6386 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006387 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6388 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6389 // already zeros.
6390 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006391 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6392 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6393 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006394 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006395 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6396 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006397 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6398 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006399 }
6400 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006401 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006402 case Instruction::ZExt:
6403 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006404 case Instruction::Trunc:
6405 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00006406 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
6407 // of casts in the input.
6408 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006409 return true;
Chris Lattner50d9d772007-09-10 23:46:29 +00006410
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006411 break;
6412 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006413 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6414 break;
6415 }
6416
6417 return false;
6418}
6419
6420/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6421/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6422/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006423Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006424 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006425 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006426 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006427
6428 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6429 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006430 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006431 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006432 case Instruction::Add:
6433 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006434 case Instruction::And:
6435 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006436 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006437 case Instruction::AShr:
6438 case Instruction::LShr:
6439 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006440 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006441 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6442 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6443 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006444 break;
6445 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006446 case Instruction::Trunc:
6447 case Instruction::ZExt:
6448 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006449 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006450 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
6451 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006452 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6453 return I->getOperand(0);
6454
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006455 // Otherwise, must be the same type of case, so just reinsert a new one.
6456 Res = CastInst::create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
6457 Ty, I->getName());
6458 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006459 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006460 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6461 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6462 break;
6463 }
6464
6465 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6466}
6467
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006468/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6469Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006470 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6471
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00006472 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006473 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006474 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006475 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6476 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6477 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6478 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6479 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006480 }
6481 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006482
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006483 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006484 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6485 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6486 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006487
6488 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006489 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6490 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6491 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006492
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006493 return 0;
6494}
6495
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006496/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
6497Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6498 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6499
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006500 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006501 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6502 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006503 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
6504 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6505 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6506 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006507 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006508 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6509 return &CI;
6510 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006511
6512 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
6513 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
6514 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
6515 // non-type-safe code.
6516 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
6517 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
6518 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
6519 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
6520 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
6521
6522 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
6523 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
6524 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
6525 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
6526 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
6527 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
6528
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006529 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
6530 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
6531 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006532 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006533 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
6534 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
6535 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
6536 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006537
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006538 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
6539 if (Offset < 0) {
6540 --FirstIdx;
6541 Offset += TySize;
6542 assert(Offset >= 0);
6543 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00006544 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006545 }
6546
6547 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006548
6549 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
6550 while (Offset) {
6551 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6552 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006553 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
6554 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
6555 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006556
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006557 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
6558 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
6559 } else {
6560 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6561 Offset = 0;
6562 OrigBase = 0;
6563 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006564 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6565 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006566 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeSize(STy->getElementType())) {
6567 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
6568 Offset %= EltSize;
6569 } else {
6570 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
6571 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006572 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
6573 } else {
6574 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6575 Offset = 0;
6576 OrigBase = 0;
6577 }
6578 }
6579 if (OrigBase) {
6580 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
6581 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
6582 // two.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00006583 Instruction *NGEP = new GetElementPtrInst(OrigBase,
6584 NewIndices.begin(),
6585 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006586 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
6587 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
6588
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006589 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
6590 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6591 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
6592 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6593 }
6594 }
6595 }
6596 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006597 }
6598
6599 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6600}
6601
6602
6603
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006604/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6605/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006606/// cases.
6607/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6608Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6609 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6610 return Result;
6611
6612 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6613 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6614 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006615 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6616 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006617
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006618 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6619 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006620 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6621 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006622 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6623 return &CI;
6624
6625 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6626 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006627 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6628 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006629 return 0;
6630
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006631 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006632 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006633 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6634 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006635 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006636 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006637 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
6638 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
6639 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
6640 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006641 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006642 bool DoXForm;
6643 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6644 default:
6645 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6646 // get here because of the check above.
6647 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6648 case Instruction::Trunc:
6649 DoXForm = true;
6650 break;
6651 case Instruction::ZExt:
6652 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6653 break;
6654 case Instruction::SExt:
6655 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6656 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006657 }
6658
6659 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006660 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6661 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006662 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6663 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6664 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6665 case Instruction::Trunc:
6666 case Instruction::BitCast:
6667 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6668 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6669 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6670 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6671 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00006672 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
6673 SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006674 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6675 }
6676 case Instruction::SExt:
6677 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6678 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006679 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6680 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006681 }
6682 }
6683 }
6684
6685 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6686 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6687
6688 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6689 case Instruction::Add:
6690 case Instruction::Mul:
6691 case Instruction::And:
6692 case Instruction::Or:
6693 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006694 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006695 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6696 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6697 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6698 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6699 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006700 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6701 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006702 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006703 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6704 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6705 return BinaryOperator::create(
6706 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006707 }
6708 }
6709
6710 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6711 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6712 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006713 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006714 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006715 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006716 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6717 }
6718 break;
6719 case Instruction::SDiv:
6720 case Instruction::UDiv:
6721 case Instruction::SRem:
6722 case Instruction::URem:
6723 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6724 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6725 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6726 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6727 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006728 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6729 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006730 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6731 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6732 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6733 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006734 return BinaryOperator::create(
6735 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6736 }
6737 }
6738 break;
6739
6740 case Instruction::Shl:
6741 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6742 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6743 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6744 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6745 // in the value.
6746 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6747 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006748 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6749 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6750 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006751 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006752 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006753 }
6754 break;
6755 case Instruction::AShr:
6756 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6757 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6758 // simplifications.
6759 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6760 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006761 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006762 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6763 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006764 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006765 }
6766 }
6767 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006768 }
6769 return 0;
6770}
6771
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006772Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006773 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6774 return Result;
6775
6776 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6777 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006778 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6779 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006780
6781 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6782 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6783 default: break;
6784 case Instruction::LShr:
6785 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6786 // are already zeros.
6787 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006788 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006789
6790 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006791 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006792 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6793 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006794 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6796
6797 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6798 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006799 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6800 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6801 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006802 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006803 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006804 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6805
6806 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6807 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6808 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006809 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006810 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6811
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006812 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006813 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006814 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006815 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6816 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6817 "tmp"), CI);
6818 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006819 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006820 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006821 }
6822 break;
6823 }
6824 }
6825
6826 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006827}
6828
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006829Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006830 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6831 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6832 return Result;
6833
6834 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6835
6836 // If this is a cast of a cast
6837 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006838 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6839 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6840 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6841 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6842 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6843 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006844 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6845 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6846 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006847 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6848 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6849 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006850 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006851 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006852 Instruction *And =
6853 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6854 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6855 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6856 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6857 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006858 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006859 }
6860 return And;
6861 }
6862 }
6863 }
6864
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006865 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6866 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6867 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6868 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6869 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006870 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006871
6872 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
6873 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
6874 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6875 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6876 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6877 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6878 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6879 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createLShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006880 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006881 CI);
6882 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6883 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6884 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6885
6886 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
6887 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6888 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006889 In->getName()+".not"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006890 CI);
6891 }
6892
6893 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6894 }
6895
6896
6897
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006898 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6899 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6900 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6901 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6902 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6903 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6904 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6905 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006906 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
6907 // This only works for EQ and NE
6908 ICI->isEquality()) {
6909 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
6910 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6911 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6912 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
6913 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6914
6915 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
6916 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
6917 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6918 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
6919 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6920 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
6921 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
6922 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
6923 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6924 }
6925
6926 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
6927 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6928 if (ShiftAmt) {
6929 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6930 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6931 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
6932 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
6933 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6934 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
6935 }
6936
6937 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
6938 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6939 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6940 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6941 }
6942
6943 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6945 else
6946 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
6947 }
6948 }
6949 }
6950 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006951 return 0;
6952}
6953
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006954Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006955 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6956 return I;
6957
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006958 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6959
6960 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
6961 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
6962 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6963 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6964 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6965 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6966 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
6967 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
6968
6969 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
6970 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
6971 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6972 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6973 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6974 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6975 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6976 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006977 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006978 CI);
6979 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6980 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6981 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6982
6983 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
6984 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(In,
6985 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
6986
6987 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6988 }
6989 }
6990 }
6991
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006992 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006993}
6994
6995Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
6996 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6997}
6998
6999Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7000 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7001}
7002
7003Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007004 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007005}
7006
7007Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007008 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007009}
7010
7011Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7012 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7013}
7014
7015Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7016 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7017}
7018
7019Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007020 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007021}
7022
7023Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
7024 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7025}
7026
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007027Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007028 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7029 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7030 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7031 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7032 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7033
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007034 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007035 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7036 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007037 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7038 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7039 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007040 } else {
7041 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7042 return Result;
7043 }
7044
7045
7046 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7047 // be replaced by the operand.
7048 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7049 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7050
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007051 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007052 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7053 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7054 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7055
7056 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7057 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7058 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7059 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7060 return V;
7061
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007062 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7063 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007064 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7065 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7066 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7067 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7068 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7069 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7070 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7071 ++NumZeros;
7072 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007073
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007074 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7075 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7076 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Chuck Rose IIIc331d302007-09-05 20:36:41 +00007077 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7078 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007079 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007080 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007081
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007082 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7083 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7084 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7085 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007086 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7087 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007088 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7089 CastInst *Tmp;
7090 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7091 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7092 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7093 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7094 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7095 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7096 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007097 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7098 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7099 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7100 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007101 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7102 // know the vector types match #elts.
7103 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007104 }
7105 }
7106 }
7107 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007108 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007109}
7110
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007111/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7112/// %C = or %A, %B
7113/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7114/// into:
7115/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7116/// %D = or %A, %C
7117///
7118/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7119/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7120/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7121///
7122static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7123 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7124 case Instruction::Add:
7125 case Instruction::Mul:
7126 case Instruction::And:
7127 case Instruction::Or:
7128 case Instruction::Xor:
7129 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7130 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7131 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007132 case Instruction::LShr:
7133 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007134 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007135 default:
7136 return 0; // Cannot fold
7137 }
7138}
7139
7140/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7141/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7142static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7143 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7144 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7145 case Instruction::Add:
7146 case Instruction::Sub:
7147 case Instruction::Or:
7148 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007149 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007150 case Instruction::LShr:
7151 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007152 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007153 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007154 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007155 case Instruction::Mul:
7156 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7157 }
7158}
7159
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007160/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7161/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7162Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7163 Instruction *FI) {
7164 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7165 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7166 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007167 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007168 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7169 return 0;
7170 } else {
7171 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7172 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007173
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007174 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
7175 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7176 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
7177 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007178 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
7179 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007180 }
7181
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007182 // Only handle binary operators here.
7183 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007184 return 0;
7185
7186 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7187 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7188 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7189 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7190 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7191 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7192 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7193 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7194 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7195 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7196 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7197 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7198 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7199 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7200 return 0;
7201 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7202 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7203 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7204 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7205 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7206 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7207 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7208 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7209 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7210 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7211 } else {
7212 return 0;
7213 }
7214
7215 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
7216 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
7217 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
7218 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
7219
7220 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
7221 if (MatchIsOpZero)
7222 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
7223 else
7224 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007225 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007226 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
7227 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007228}
7229
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007230Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007231 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
7232 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
7233 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
7234
7235 // select true, X, Y -> X
7236 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007237 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007238 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007239
7240 // select C, X, X -> X
7241 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
7242 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7243
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007244 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
7245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7246 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
7247 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7248 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
7249 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7251 else
7252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7253 }
7254
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007255 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007256 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007257 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007258 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007259 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007260 } else {
7261 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
7262 Value *NotCond =
7263 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7264 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007265 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007266 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007267 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007268 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007269 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007270 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007271 } else {
7272 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
7273 Value *NotCond =
7274 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7275 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007276 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007277 }
7278 }
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007279 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007280
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007281 // Selecting between two integer constants?
7282 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
7283 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007284 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007285 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007286 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007287 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007288 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007289 Value *NotCond =
7290 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007291 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007292 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007293 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007294
7295 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007296
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007297 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007298
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007299 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007300 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007301 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007302 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007303 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007304 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007305 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007306 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007307 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
7308 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
7309 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007310 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
7311
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007312 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
7313 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
7314 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007315 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7316 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007317 if (SRASize < SISize)
7318 opc = Instruction::SExt;
7319 else if (SRASize > SISize)
7320 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
7321 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007322 }
7323 }
7324
7325
7326 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007327 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007328 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
7329 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007330 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00007331 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007332 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7333 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
7334 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007335 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
7336 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
7337 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007338 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
7339 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007340 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
7341 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007342 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007343 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007344 Value *V = ICA;
7345 if (ShouldNotVal)
7346 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
7347 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
7348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
7349 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007350 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007351 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007352
7353 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007354 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7355 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007356 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007357 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7359 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007360 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7362 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7363
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007364 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007365 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007366 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007368 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007369 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
7370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7371 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7372 }
7373 }
7374
7375 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
7376 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7377 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
7378 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
7379 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7380 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7381 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
7382 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
7383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7384 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7385
7386 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
7387 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
7388 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7389 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7390 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
7391 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007393 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7394 }
7395 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007396
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007397 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7398 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7399 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007400 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
7401
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007402 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
7403 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
7404 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
7405 return IV;
7406
7407 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
7408 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007409 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7410 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7411 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
7412 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7413 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7414 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
7415 }
7416
7417 if (AddOp) {
7418 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
7419 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
7420 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
7421 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7422 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7423 }
7424
7425 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007426 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7427 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7428 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7429 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7430 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7431 } else {
7432 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7433 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007434 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007435
7436 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7437 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7438 if (AddOp != TI)
7439 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7440 Instruction *NewSel =
7441 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7442
7443 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7444 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007445 }
7446 }
7447 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007448
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007449 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007450 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007451 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7452 // transformation we are doing here.
7453 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7454 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7455 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7456 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7457 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7458 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7459 OpToFold = 1;
7460 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7461 OpToFold = 2;
7462 }
7463
7464 if (OpToFold) {
7465 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007466 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007467 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007468 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007469 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007470 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7471 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007472 else {
7473 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7474 }
7475 }
7476 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007477
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007478 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7479 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7480 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7481 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7482 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7483 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7484 OpToFold = 1;
7485 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7486 OpToFold = 2;
7487 }
7488
7489 if (OpToFold) {
7490 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007491 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007492 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007493 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007494 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007495 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7496 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007497 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007498 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007499 }
7500 }
7501 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007502
7503 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7504 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7505 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7506 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7507 return &SI;
7508 }
7509
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007510 return 0;
7511}
7512
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007513/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
7514/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
7515/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
7516/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
7517static unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD,
7518 unsigned PrefAlign = 0) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007519 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7520 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
7521 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007522 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007523
7524 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
7525 // of the global.
7526 if (PrefAlign > Align && GV->hasInitializer()) {
7527 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7528 Align = PrefAlign;
7529 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007530 return Align;
7531 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7532 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7533 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7534 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007535 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007536 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7537 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007538 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007539 Align =
7540 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007541 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007542 Align =
7543 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007544 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007545 }
7546 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007547
7548 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
7549 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
7550 if (PrefAlign > Align && isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
7551 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7552 Align = PrefAlign;
7553 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007554 return Align;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007555 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007556 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007557 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007558 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(cast<User>(V)->getOperand(0),
7559 TD, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007560 } else if (User *GEPI = dyn_castGetElementPtr(V)) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007561 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7562 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7563 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7564 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7565 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7566 AllZeroOperands = false;
7567 break;
7568 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007569
7570 if (AllZeroOperands) {
7571 // Treat this like a bitcast.
7572 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD, PrefAlign);
7573 }
7574
7575 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0),TD);
7576 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7577
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007578 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7579 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7580 // least as much as its type requires.
7581 if (!TD) return 0;
7582
7583 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007584 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007585 unsigned Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType());
7586 if (Align <= BaseAlignment) {
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007587 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007588 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007589 Align = std::min(Align, (unsigned)
7590 TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType()));
7591 return Align;
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007592 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007593 return 0;
7594 }
7595 return 0;
7596}
7597
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007598
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007599/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7600/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7601/// the heavy lifting.
7602///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007603Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007604 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7605 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7606
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007607 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7608 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007609 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007610 bool Changed = false;
7611
7612 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7613 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7614 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7615
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007616 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007617 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007618 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7619 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7620 // alignment is sufficient.
7621 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007622 }
7623
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007624 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7625 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7626 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007627 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007628 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7629 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7630 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007631 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth8ed4c472006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007632 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007633 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007634 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7635 else
7636 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattner92141962007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007637 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007638 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7639 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7640 Changed = true;
7641 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007642 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007643
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007644 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7645 // set, update the alignment.
7646 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007647 unsigned Alignment1 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7648 unsigned Alignment2 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007649 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007650 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007651 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007652 Changed = true;
7653 }
7654 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007655 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007656 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007657 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007658 Changed = true;
7659 }
7660 }
7661
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007662 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007663 } else {
7664 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7665 default: break;
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007666 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7667 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007668 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7669 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7670 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7671 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7672 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007673 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007674 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007675 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007676 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7677 }
7678 break;
7679 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7680 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7681 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007682 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007683 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007684 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7685 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007686 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7687 }
7688 break;
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007689 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7690 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7691 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7692 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7693 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007694 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007695 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007696 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7697 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007698 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7699 }
7700 break;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007701
7702 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7703 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7704 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7705 uint64_t UndefElts;
7706 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7707 UndefElts)) {
7708 II->setOperand(1, V);
7709 return II;
7710 }
7711 break;
7712 }
7713
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007714 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7715 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007716 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007717 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7718
7719 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7720 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7721 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7722 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7723 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7724 AllEltsOk = false;
7725 break;
7726 }
7727 }
7728
7729 if (AllEltsOk) {
7730 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007731 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7732 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7733 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7734 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007735 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7736
7737 // Only extract each element once.
7738 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7739 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7740
7741 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7742 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7743 continue;
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007744 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007745 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7746
7747 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7748 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007749 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007750 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7751 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7752 }
7753
7754 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007755 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007756 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7757 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007758 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007759 }
7760 }
7761 break;
7762
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007763 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7764 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7765 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7766 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7767 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7768 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7769 if (&*++BI == II)
7770 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7771 }
7772 }
7773
7774 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7775 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7776 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7777 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7778 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7779 bool CannotRemove = false;
7780 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7781 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7782 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7783 CannotRemove = true;
7784 break;
7785 }
7786 }
7787 if (!CannotRemove)
7788 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7789 }
7790 break;
7791 }
7792 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007793 }
7794
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007795 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007796}
7797
7798// InvokeInst simplification
7799//
7800Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007801 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007802}
7803
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007804// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7805//
7806Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007807 bool Changed = false;
7808
7809 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7810 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007811 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7812
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007813 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007814
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007815 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7816 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7817 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7818 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7819 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007820 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007821 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007822 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7823 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7824 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7825 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7826 return 0;
7827 }
7828
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007829 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7830 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7831 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7832 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007833 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007834 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007835 CS.getInstruction());
7836
7837 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7838 CS.getInstruction()->
7839 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7840
7841 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7842 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7843 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007844 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007845 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007846 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7847 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007848
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00007849 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
7850 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
7851 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
7852 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
7853
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007854 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7855 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7856 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7857 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7858 // the call.
7859 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7860 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7861 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7862 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7863 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7864 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007865 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007866 *I = Op;
7867 Changed = true;
7868 }
7869 }
7870 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007871
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007872 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007873}
7874
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007875// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7876// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7877//
7878bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7879 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7880 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007881 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7882 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007883 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007884 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007885 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7886
7887 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7888 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7889 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7890 //
7891 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7892 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7893
Chris Lattnera2b18de2007-05-19 06:51:32 +00007894 const FunctionType *ActualFT =
7895 cast<FunctionType>(cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType());
7896
7897 // If the parameter attributes don't match up, don't do the xform. We don't
7898 // want to lose an sret attribute or something.
7899 if (FT->getParamAttrs() != ActualFT->getParamAttrs())
7900 return false;
7901
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007902 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7903 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007904 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007905 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7906 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7907 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007908 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007909
7910 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
7911 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
7912 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
7913 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
7914 if (!Caller->use_empty())
7915 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
7916 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
7917 UI != E; ++UI)
7918 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
7919 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007920 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007921 return false;
7922 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007923
7924 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
7925 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007926
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007927 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
7928 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
7929 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007930 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007931 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007932 //Some conversions are safe even if we do not have a body.
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007933 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007934 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007935 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007936 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007937 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
7938 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00007939 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007940 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007941
7942 // Most other conversions can be done if we have a body, even if these
7943 // lose information, e.g. int->short.
7944 // Some conversions cannot be done at all, e.g. float to pointer.
7945 // Logic here parallels CastInst::getCastOpcode (the design there
7946 // requires legality checks like this be done before calling it).
7947 if (ParamTy->isInteger()) {
7948 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7949 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7950 return false;
7951 }
7952 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint() &&
7953 !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7954 return false;
7955 } else if (ParamTy->isFloatingPoint()) {
7956 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7957 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7958 return false;
7959 }
7960 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint())
7961 return false;
7962 } else if (const VectorType *VParamTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ParamTy)) {
7963 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7964 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != VParamTy->getBitWidth())
7965 return false;
7966 }
7967 if (VParamTy->getBitWidth() != ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7968 return false;
7969 } else if (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy)) {
7970 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7971 return false;
7972 } else {
7973 return false;
7974 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007975 }
7976
7977 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007978 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007979 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
7980
7981 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
7982 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
7983 std::vector<Value*> Args;
7984 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
7985
7986 AI = CS.arg_begin();
7987 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7988 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
7989 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
7990 Args.push_back(*AI);
7991 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007992 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007993 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007994 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007995 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007996 }
7997 }
7998
7999 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
8000 // now...
8001 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
8002 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
8003
8004 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
8005 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
8006 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00008007 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
8008 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008009 } else {
8010 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
8011 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8012 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
8013 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
8014 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008015 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
8016 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008017 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008018 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
8019 Args.push_back(Cast);
8020 } else {
8021 Args.push_back(*AI);
8022 }
8023 }
8024 }
8025
8026 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008027 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008028
8029 Instruction *NC;
8030 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008031 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
David Greenef1355a52007-08-27 19:04:21 +00008032 Args.begin(), Args.end(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00008033 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008034 } else {
Chris Lattner684b22d2007-08-02 16:53:43 +00008035 NC = new CallInst(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
8036 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00008037 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
8038 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattnere4370262005-05-14 12:25:32 +00008039 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008040 }
8041
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008042 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008043 Value *NV = NC;
8044 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8045 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008046 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008047 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
8048 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008049 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00008050
8051 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
8052 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
8053 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8054 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
8055 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
8056 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
8057 } else {
8058 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
8059 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
8060 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008061 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008062 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00008063 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008064 }
8065 }
8066
8067 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8068 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00008069 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008070 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008071 return true;
8072}
8073
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008074// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
8075// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
8076//
8077Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
8078 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
8079 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8080 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8081
8082 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
8083 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
8084
8085 Function *NestF =
8086 cast<Function>(IntrinsicInst::StripPointerCasts(Tramp->getOperand(2)));
8087 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
8088 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
8089
8090 if (const ParamAttrsList *NestAttrs = NestFTy->getParamAttrs()) {
8091 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
8092 const Type *NestTy = 0;
8093 uint16_t NestAttr = 0;
8094
8095 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
8096 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
8097 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
8098 if (NestAttrs->paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
8099 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
8100 NestTy = *I;
8101 NestAttr = NestAttrs->getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
8102 break;
8103 }
8104
8105 if (NestTy) {
8106 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
8107 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
8108 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
8109
8110 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
8111 // mean appending it.
8112 {
8113 unsigned Idx = 1;
8114 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
8115 do {
8116 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
8117 // Add the chain argument.
8118 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
8119 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
8120 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
8121 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
8122 }
8123
8124 if (I == E)
8125 break;
8126
8127 // Add the original argument.
8128 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
8129
8130 ++Idx, ++I;
8131 } while (1);
8132 }
8133
8134 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
8135 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
8136 // with the chain parameter inserted. Likewise for attributes.
8137
8138 const ParamAttrsList *Attrs = FTy->getParamAttrs();
8139 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
8140 ParamAttrsVector NewAttrs;
8141 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
8142
8143 // Add any function result attributes.
8144 uint16_t Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(0) : 0;
8145 if (Attr)
8146 NewAttrs.push_back (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
8147
8148 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
8149 // mean appending it. Likewise for the chain's attributes.
8150 {
8151 unsigned Idx = 1;
8152 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
8153 E = FTy->param_end();
8154
8155 do {
8156 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
8157 // Add the chain's type and attributes.
8158 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
8159 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
8160 }
8161
8162 if (I == E)
8163 break;
8164
8165 // Add the original type and attributes.
8166 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
8167 Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(Idx) : 0;
8168 if (Attr)
8169 NewAttrs.push_back
8170 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
8171
8172 ++Idx, ++I;
8173 } while (1);
8174 }
8175
8176 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
8177 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
8178 FunctionType *NewFTy =
8179 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg(),
8180 ParamAttrsList::get(NewAttrs));
8181 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::get(NewFTy) ?
8182 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::get(NewFTy));
8183
8184 Instruction *NewCaller;
8185 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8186 NewCaller = new InvokeInst(NewCallee,
8187 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8188 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
8189 Caller->getName(), Caller);
8190 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
8191 } else {
8192 NewCaller = new CallInst(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
8193 Caller->getName(), Caller);
8194 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
8195 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
8196 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
8197 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
8198 }
8199 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8200 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
8201 Caller->eraseFromParent();
8202 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
8203 return 0;
8204 }
8205 }
8206
8207 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
8208 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
8209 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
8210 Constant *NewCallee =
8211 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
8212 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
8213 return CS.getInstruction();
8214}
8215
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008216/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
8217/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
8218/// and a single binop.
8219Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8220 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008221 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
8222 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008223 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008224 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8225 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
8226
8227 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
8228 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008229
8230 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
8231 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008232 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008233 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008234 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008235 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008236 // types or GEP's with different index types.
8237 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
8238 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008239 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008240
8241 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
8242 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
8243 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
8244 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
8245 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008246
8247 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
8248 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
8249 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008250 }
8251
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008252 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
8253
8254 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
8255 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
8256 // hide them behind a phi.
8257 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
8258 return 0;
8259
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008260 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008261 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008262 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008263 if (LHSVal == 0) {
8264 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
8265 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8266 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008267 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
8268 LHSVal = NewLHS;
8269 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008270
8271 if (RHSVal == 0) {
8272 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
8273 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8274 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008275 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
8276 RHSVal = NewRHS;
8277 }
8278
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008279 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
8280 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8281 if (NewLHS) {
8282 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8283 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8284 }
8285 if (NewRHS) {
8286 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
8287 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8288 }
8289 }
8290
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008291 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008292 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008293 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8294 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
8295 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008296 else {
8297 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
8298 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
8299 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008300}
8301
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008302/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
8303/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
8304/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
8305/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008306///
8307/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
8308/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
8309/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008310static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
8311 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
8312
8313 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
8314 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
8315 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008316
8317 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
8318 // profitable to do this xform.
8319 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
8320 bool isAddressTaken = false;
8321 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
8322 UI != E; ++UI) {
8323 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
8324 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
8325 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
8326 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
8327 }
8328 isAddressTaken = true;
8329 break;
8330 }
8331
8332 if (!isAddressTaken)
8333 return false;
8334 }
8335
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008336 return true;
8337}
8338
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008339
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008340// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
8341// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
8342// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
8343Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8344 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
8345
8346 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
8347 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
8348 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
8349 // code size and simplifying code.
8350 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
8351 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008352 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008353 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
8354 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008355 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008356 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
8357 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008358 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008359 if (ConstantOp == 0)
8360 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008361 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
8362 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
8363 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
8364 // load and the PHI.
8365 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
8366 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8367 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008368 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008369 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008370 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
8371 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
8372 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008373 } else {
8374 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
8375 }
8376
8377 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
8378 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8379 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
8380 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008381 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008382 return 0;
8383 if (CastSrcTy) {
8384 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
8385 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008386 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008387 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
8388 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008389 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
8390 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
8391 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8392 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008393 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
8394 return 0;
8395 }
8396 }
8397
8398 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
8399 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
8400 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8401 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00008402 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008403
8404 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8405 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008406
8407 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008408 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8409 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8410 if (NewInVal != InVal)
8411 InVal = 0;
8412 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8413 }
8414
8415 Value *PhiVal;
8416 if (InVal) {
8417 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
8418 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
8419 PhiVal = InVal;
8420 delete NewPN;
8421 } else {
8422 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
8423 PhiVal = NewPN;
8424 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008425
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008426 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008427 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
8428 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008429 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008430 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008431 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008432 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008433 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8434 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
8435 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008436 else
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008437 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenca5183d2007-03-05 00:00:42 +00008438 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008439}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008440
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008441/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
8442/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008443static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
8444 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008445 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
8446 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
8447
8448 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008449 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008450 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00008451
8452 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
8453 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
8454 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008455
8456 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
8457 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008458
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008459 return false;
8460}
8461
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008462// PHINode simplification
8463//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008464Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00008465 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00008466 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00008467
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008468 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
8469 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
8470
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008471 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
8472 // reducing code size.
8473 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
8474 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
8475 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
8476 return Result;
8477
8478 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
8479 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
8480 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008481 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
8482 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
8483 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008484 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008485 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
8486 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
8487 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8488 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008489
8490 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
8491 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
8492 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
8493 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
8494 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
8495 // late.
8496 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
8497 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
8498 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
8499 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8500 }
8501 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008502
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00008503 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008504}
8505
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008506static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
8507 Instruction *InsertPoint,
8508 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008509 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8510 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008511 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
8512 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
8513 // used for address computation.
8514 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
8515 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
8516 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
8517 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008518}
8519
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008520
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008521Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008522 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008523 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008524 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008525 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008526 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008527
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008528 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
8529 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
8530
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008531 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
8532 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
8533 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
8534
8535 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008537
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008538 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
8539 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008540
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008541 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008542 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008543 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
8544 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00008545 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
8546 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
8547 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
8548 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
8549 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
8550 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8551 MadeChange = true;
8552 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008553 }
8554 }
8555 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008556 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
8557 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
8558 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
8559 // obvious.
8560 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008561 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008562 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008563 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008564 MadeChange = true;
8565 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008566 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
8567 GEP);
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008568 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
8569 MadeChange = true;
8570 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008571 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008572 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008573 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
8574
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008575 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
8576 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
8577 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008578 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008579 return new BitCastInst(cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0),
8580 GEP.getType());
8581
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008582 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
8583 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
8584 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
8585 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008586 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00008587 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008588 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008589
8590 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008591 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
8592 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
8593 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
8594 //
8595 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
8596 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
8597 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
8598
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008599 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008600
8601 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
8602 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
8603 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
8604 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00008605 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008606
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008607 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008608 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00008609 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
8610 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
8611 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008612 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008613 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
8614 Sum = GO1;
8615 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
8616 Sum = SO1;
8617 } else {
8618 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
8619 // target's pointer size.
8620 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
8621 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008622 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008623 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008624 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008625 } else {
8626 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008627 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008628 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008629 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008630
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008631 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008632 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008633 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008634 } else {
8635 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008636 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8637 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008638 }
8639 }
8640 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008641 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8642 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8643 else {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008644 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8645 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008646 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008647 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008648
8649 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8650 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8651 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8652 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8653 return &GEP;
8654 } else {
8655 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8656 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8657 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8658 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8659 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008660 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008661 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008662 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008663 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008664 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8665 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008666 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8667 }
8668
8669 if (!Indices.empty())
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008670 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
8671 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008672
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008673 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008674 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8675 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8676
8677 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008678 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008679 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8680 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8681 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8682
8683 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008684 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8685 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008686
8687 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8689 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008690 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008691 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8692 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8693 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8694 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8695 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8696 //
8697 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8698 //
8699 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8700 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8701 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8702 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8703 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8704 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8705 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8706 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8707 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8708 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8709 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8710 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8711 return &GEP;
8712 }
8713 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8714 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008715 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8716 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008717 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8718 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8719 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
8720 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8721 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008722 Value *Idx[2];
8723 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8724 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008725 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008726 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008727 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8728 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008729 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008730
8731 // Transform things like:
8732 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8733 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8734 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8735
8736 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008737 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008738 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
8739 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
8740
8741 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8742 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8743 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8744 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8745 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8746 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8747 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8748 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008749 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008750 Scale = CI;
8751 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8752 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8753 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00008754 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8755 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
8756 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008757 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8758 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8759 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8760 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8761 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8762 }
8763 }
8764
8765 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8766 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008767 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008768 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008769 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8770 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8771 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008772 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8773 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008774 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8775 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8776 }
8777
8778 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008779 Value *Idx[2];
8780 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8781 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008782 Instruction *NewGEP =
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008783 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008784 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8785 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8786 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008787 }
8788 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008789 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008790 }
8791
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008792 return 0;
8793}
8794
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008795Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8796 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8797 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008798 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8799 const Type *NewTy =
8800 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008801 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008802
8803 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8804 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008805 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008806 else {
8807 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008808 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008809 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008810
8811 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008812
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008813 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8814 // allocas if possible...
8815 //
8816 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8817 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8818
8819 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8820 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8821 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008822 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008823 Value *Idx[2];
8824 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
8825 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
8826 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
Chris Lattner693787a2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008827 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008828
8829 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8830 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008832 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8833 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008834 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008835
8836 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
8837 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
8838 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008839 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattnercf27afb2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00008840 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008841 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8842
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008843 return 0;
8844}
8845
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008846Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8847 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8848
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008849 // free undef -> unreachable.
8850 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8851 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008852 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008853 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008854 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8855 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008856
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008857 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8858 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008859 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008860 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008861
8862 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8863 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
8864 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8865 return &FI;
8866 }
8867
8868 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
8869 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
8870 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8871 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
8872 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
8873 return &FI;
8874 }
8875 }
8876
8877 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
8878 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
8879 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
8880 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8881 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
8882 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008883
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008884 return 0;
8885}
8886
8887
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008888/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008889static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8890 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008891 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008892
8893 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008894 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008895 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008896
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008897 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008898 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008899 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8900 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8901 // constants.
8902 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8903 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8904 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008905 Value *Idxs[2];
8906 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8907 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008908 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8909 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8910 }
8911
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008912 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008913 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008914 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8915 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8916 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008917 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8918 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008919
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008920 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8921 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8922 // the result of the loaded value.
8923 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8924 CI->getName(),
8925 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8926 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008927 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008928 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008929 }
8930 }
8931 return 0;
8932}
8933
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008934/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008935/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8936/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8937/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8938static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00008939 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
8940 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
8941
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +00008942 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00008943 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +00008944 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00008945 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008946
8947 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8948 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008949 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8950 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8951 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008952 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8953
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008954 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008955 --BBI;
8956
8957 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8958 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8959 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8960 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008961
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008962 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008963 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008964}
8965
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00008966/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
8967/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
8968/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
8969/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
8970static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
8971 while (1) {
8972 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
8973 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
8974 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
8975 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
8976 else
8977 return Ptr;
8978 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
8979 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
8980 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
8981 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
8982 } else {
8983 return Ptr;
8984 }
8985 }
8986}
8987
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008988Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8989 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008990
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008991 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008992 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008993 if (KnownAlign > LI.getAlignment())
8994 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
8995
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008996 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008997 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008998 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8999 return Res;
9000
9001 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
9002 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009003
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009004 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
9005 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00009006 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
9007 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009008 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
9009 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
9010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00009011 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
9012 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
9013 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009014 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009015
9016 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009017 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009018 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
9019 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
9020 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
9021 // CFG.
9022 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9023 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
9024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9025 }
9026
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009027 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009028 // load null/undef -> undef
9029 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009030 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
9031 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
9032 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009033 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9034 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009035 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009036 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009037
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009038 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
9039 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009040 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009041 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009042
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009043 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
9044 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
9045 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
9046 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009047 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +00009048 if (Constant *V =
9049 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009050 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009051 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
9052 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
9053 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
9054 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
9055 // CFG.
9056 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9057 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
9058 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9059 }
9060
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009061 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009062 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
9063 return Res;
9064 }
9065 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00009066
9067 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
9068 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
9069 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
9070 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
9071 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
9072 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
9073 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
9074 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9075 }
9076 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +00009077
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009078 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009079 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
9080 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
9081 // exposes redundancy in the code.
9082 //
9083 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
9084 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
9085 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
9086 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
9087 // unconditionally.
9088 //
9089 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
9090 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009091 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
9092 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009093 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009094 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009095 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009096 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009097 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
9098 }
9099
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +00009100 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
9101 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
9102 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9103 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
9104 return &LI;
9105 }
9106
9107 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
9108 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
9109 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9110 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
9111 return &LI;
9112 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009113 }
9114 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009115 return 0;
9116}
9117
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +00009118/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009119/// when possible.
9120static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
9121 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
9122 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
9123
9124 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9125 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
9126 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9127
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009128 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009129 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
9130 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
9131 // constants.
9132 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
9133 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
9134 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009135 Value* Idxs[2];
9136 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9137 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009138 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
9139 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9140 }
9141
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009142 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
9143 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
9144 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009145
9146 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009147 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
9148 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009149 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009150 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009151 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
9152 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
9153 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
9154 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
9155 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009156 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009157 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00009158 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009159 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
9160 }
9161 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009162 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009163 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009164 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009165 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
9166 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009167 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
9168 }
9169 }
9170 }
9171 return 0;
9172}
9173
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009174Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
9175 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
9176 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
9177
9178 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009179 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009180 ++NumCombined;
9181 return 0;
9182 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00009183
9184 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
9185 // alloca dead.
9186 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
9187 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
9188 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9189 ++NumCombined;
9190 return 0;
9191 }
9192
9193 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
9194 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
9195 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
9196 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9197 ++NumCombined;
9198 return 0;
9199 }
9200 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009201
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009202 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009203 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009204 if (KnownAlign > SI.getAlignment())
9205 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
9206
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009207 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
9208 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
9209 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
9210 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
9211 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
9212 --ScanInsts) {
9213 --BBI;
9214
9215 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
9216 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
9217 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
9218 ++NumDeadStore;
9219 ++BBI;
9220 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
9221 continue;
9222 }
9223 break;
9224 }
9225
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009226 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
9227 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
9228 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
9229 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +00009230 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009231 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9232 ++NumCombined;
9233 return 0;
9234 }
9235 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
9236 // may not be dead.
9237 break;
9238 }
9239
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009240 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009241 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009242 break;
9243 }
9244
9245
9246 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009247
9248 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
9249 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
9250 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
9251 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
9252 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009253 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009254 ++NumCombined;
9255 }
9256 return 0; // Do not modify these!
9257 }
9258
9259 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
9260 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009261 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009262 ++NumCombined;
9263 return 0;
9264 }
9265
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009266 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
9267 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009268 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009269 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9270 return Res;
9271 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009272 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009273 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9274 return Res;
9275
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009276
9277 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
9278 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009279 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009280 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009281 if (BI->isUnconditional())
9282 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
9283 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009284
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009285 return 0;
9286}
9287
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009288/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
9289/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
9290/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9291///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009292/// Simplify things like:
9293/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
9294/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9295///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009296bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
9297 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
9298
9299 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
9300 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
9301 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009302 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009303
9304 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
9305 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009306 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
9307 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009308 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009309 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009310 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009311 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009312 return false;
9313
9314 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009315 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009316 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009317 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009318 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009319 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009320 return false;
9321
9322
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009323 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
9324 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009325 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009326 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009327 return false;
9328
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009329 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
9330 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
9331 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
9332 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
9333 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
9334 --BBI;
9335 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
9336 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9337 return false;
9338 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009339 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009340 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
9341 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
9342 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
9343 return false;
9344
9345 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009346 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
9347 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009348 for (;; --BBI) {
9349 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
9350 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
9351 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9352 return false;
9353 break;
9354 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009355 // If we find something that may be using the stored value, or if we run
9356 // out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009357 if (isa<LoadInst>(BBI) || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
9358 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
9359 return false;
9360 }
9361
9362 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
9363 // make sure nothing reads the stored value in StoreBB.
9364 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
9365 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
9366 if (isa<LoadInst>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory())
9367 return false;
9368 }
9369 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009370
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009371 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009372 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
9373 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
9374 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
9375 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
9376 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009377 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
9378 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009379 }
9380
9381 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
9382 // insert it.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009383 BBI = DestBB->begin();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009384 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
9385 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
9386 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
9387
9388 // Nuke the old stores.
9389 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9390 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
9391 ++NumCombined;
9392 return true;
9393}
9394
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009395
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009396Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
9397 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00009398 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009399 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
9400 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
9401 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
9402 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
9403 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9404 BI.setCondition(X);
9405 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9406 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
9407 return &BI;
9408 }
9409
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009410 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
9411 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
9412 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9413 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9414 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
9415 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9416 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009417 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009418 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9419 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009420 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9421 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
9422 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9423 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009424 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009425 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009426 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009427 return &BI;
9428 }
9429
9430 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
9431 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
9432 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9433 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9434 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
9435 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
9436 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9437 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009438 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009439 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9440 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009441 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009442 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009443 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9444 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009445 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009446 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009447 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009448 return &BI;
9449 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009450
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009451 return 0;
9452}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009453
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009454Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
9455 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
9456 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
9457 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
9458 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
9459 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
9460 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009461 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009462 AddRHS));
9463 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009464 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009465 return &SI;
9466 }
9467 }
9468 return 0;
9469}
9470
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009471/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
9472/// is to leave as a vector operation.
9473static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
9474 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9475 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009476 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009477 if (isConstant) return true;
9478 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
9479 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
9480 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
9481 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
9482 return false;
9483 return true;
9484 }
9485 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9486 if (!I) return false;
9487
9488 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
9489 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
9490 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
9491 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
9492 return true;
9493 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
9494 return true;
9495 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
9496 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
9497 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9498 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9499 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009500 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
9501 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
9502 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9503 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9504 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009505
9506 return false;
9507}
9508
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00009509/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
9510///
9511/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
9512/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009513static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
9514 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9515 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9516 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
9517 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9518 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
9519
9520 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009521 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009522 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9523 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
9524 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
9525 else
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009526 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009527 return Result;
9528}
9529
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009530/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
9531/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
9532/// extracted from the vector.
9533static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009534 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
9535 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009536 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
9537 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009538 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9539
9540 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
9541 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9542 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9543 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009544 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009545 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
9546 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9547 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009548 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
9549 return 0;
9550 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009551
9552 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
9553 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009554 if (EltNo == IIElt)
9555 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009556
9557 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
9558 // vector input.
9559 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009560 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009561 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
9562 if (InEl < Width)
9563 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
9564 else if (InEl < Width*2)
9565 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
9566 else
9567 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009568 }
9569
9570 // Otherwise, we don't know.
9571 return 0;
9572}
9573
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009574Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009575
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009576 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009577 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9579
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009580 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009581 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9582 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
9583
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009584 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009585 // If vector val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009586 // with that operand
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009587 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009588 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009589 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
9590 op0 = 0;
9591 break;
9592 }
9593 if (op0)
9594 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009595 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009596
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009597 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
9598 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009599 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009600 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
9601 unsigned VectorWidth =
9602 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
9603
9604 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
9605 // crashing the code below.
9606 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
9607 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9608
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009609 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
9610 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
9611 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009612 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009613 uint64_t UndefElts;
9614 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009615 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009616 UndefElts)) {
9617 EI.setOperand(0, V);
9618 return &EI;
9619 }
9620 }
9621
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009622 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009623 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +00009624
9625 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
9626 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
9627 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
9628 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
9629 if (const VectorType *VT =
9630 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
9631 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
9632 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
9633 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
9634 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009635 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009636
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009637 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009638 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9639 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
9640 // profitable to do so
9641 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009642 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
9643 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
9644 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
9645 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
9646 EI.getName()+".lhs");
9647 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
9648 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
9649 EI.getName()+".rhs");
9650 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
9651 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
9652 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
9653 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009654 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009655 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009656 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
9657 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencerde331242006-11-29 01:11:01 +00009658 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009659 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
9660 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009661 }
9662 }
9663 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
9664 // Extracting the inserted element?
9665 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
9666 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
9667 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
9668 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
9669 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
9670 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9671 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
9672 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
9673 return &EI;
9674 }
9675 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
9676 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
9677 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009678 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9679 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009680 Value *Src;
9681 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
9682 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
9683 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
9684 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9685 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
9686 } else {
9687 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00009688 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009689 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009690 }
9691 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009692 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009693 return 0;
9694}
9695
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009696/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
9697/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
9698/// Otherwise, return false.
9699static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
9700 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
9701 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
9702 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009703 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009704
9705 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009706 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009707 return true;
9708 } else if (V == LHS) {
9709 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009710 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009711 return true;
9712 } else if (V == RHS) {
9713 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009714 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009715 return true;
9716 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9717 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9718 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9719 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9720 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9721
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009722 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
9723 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009724 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009725
9726 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
9727 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9728 // transitively ok.
9729 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9730 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009731 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009732 return true;
9733 }
9734 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
9735 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009736 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9737 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009738 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009739
9740 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
9741 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
9742 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9743 // transitively ok.
9744 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9745 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
9746 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
9747 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009748 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009749 } else {
9750 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
9751 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009752 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009753
9754 }
9755 return true;
9756 }
9757 }
9758 }
9759 }
9760 }
9761 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
9762
9763 return false;
9764}
9765
9766/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
9767/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
9768/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009769static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009770 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009771 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009772 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009773 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009774 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009775
9776 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009777 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009778 return V;
9779 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009780 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009781 return V;
9782 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9783 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9784 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9785 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9786 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9787
9788 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9789 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9790 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9791 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009792 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9793 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009794
9795 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9796 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009797 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
9798 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
9799 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009800 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009801 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009802 return V;
9803 }
9804
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009805 if (VecOp == RHS) {
9806 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009807 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
9808 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
9809 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009810 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009811 }
9812 return V;
9813 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009814
9815 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
9816 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
9817 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
9818 return EI->getOperand(0);
9819
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009820 }
9821 }
9822 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009823 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009824
9825 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
9826 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009827 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009828 return V;
9829}
9830
9831Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
9832 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
9833 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
9834 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
9835
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +00009836 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
9837 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
9838 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9839
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009840 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
9841 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
9842 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9843 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9844 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
9845 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00009846 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
9847 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009848 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009849
9850 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
9851 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9852
9853 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
9854 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
9855
9856 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
9857 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
9858 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
9859 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9860
9861 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
9862 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
9863 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
9864 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
9865 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
9866 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
9867 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
9868 // Build a new shuffle mask.
9869 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
9870 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009871 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009872 else {
9873 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009874 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009875 NumVectorElts));
9876 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009877 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009878 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009879 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009880 }
9881
9882 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
9883 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
9884 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
9885 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009886 Value *RHS = 0;
9887 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
9888 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
9889 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009890 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009891 }
9892 }
9893 }
9894
9895 return 0;
9896}
9897
9898
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009899Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
9900 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9901 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009902 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009903
9904 bool MadeChange = false;
9905
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009906 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009907 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009908 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
9909
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009910 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009911 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009912 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
9913 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
9914 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
9915 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9916 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
9917 Mask[i] = 2*e;
9918 MadeChange = true;
9919 }
9920 }
9921
9922 if (MadeChange) {
9923 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9924 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9925 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9926 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
9927 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
9928 else
9929 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
9930 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009931 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009932 }
9933 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009934
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009935 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
9936 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
9937 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
9938 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009939 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
9940 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9941 }
9942
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009943 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9944 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9945 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009946 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009947 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009948 else {
9949 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
9950 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
9951 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
9952 else
9953 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009954 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009955 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009956 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009957 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009958 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009959 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009960 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9961 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009962 MadeChange = true;
9963 }
9964
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009965 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009966 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009967
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009968 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9969 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
9970 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
9971 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
9972
9973 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
9974 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009975 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009976
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009977 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
9978 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9979 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009980
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009981 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9982 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9983 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9984 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9985 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9986 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9987 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9988 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9989 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9990 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9991 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9992 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9993
9994 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9995 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9996 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9997 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9998 else
9999 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
10000
10001 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
10002 // the replacement.
10003 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
10004 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
10005 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10006 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010007 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010008 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010009 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010010 }
10011 }
10012 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
10013 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010014 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010015 }
10016 }
10017 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000010018
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010019 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
10020}
10021
10022
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010023
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010024
10025/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
10026/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
10027/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
10028/// end of its block.
10029static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
10030 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
10031
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000010032 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
10033 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010034
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010035 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000010036 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
10037 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010038 return false;
10039
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010040 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
10041 // the end of block that could change the value.
10042 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010043 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
10044 Scan != E; ++Scan)
10045 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
10046 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010047 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010048
10049 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
10050 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
10051
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000010052 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010053 ++NumSunkInst;
10054 return true;
10055}
10056
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010057
10058/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
10059/// all reachable code to the worklist.
10060///
10061/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
10062/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
10063/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
10064/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
10065/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
10066///
10067static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010068 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010069 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010070 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010071 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
10072 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010073
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010074 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10075 BB = Worklist.back();
10076 Worklist.pop_back();
10077
10078 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
10079 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
10080
10081 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
10082 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010083
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010084 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
10085 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
10086 ++NumDeadInst;
10087 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
10088 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10089 continue;
10090 }
10091
10092 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
10093 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
10094 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
10095 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
10096 ++NumConstProp;
10097 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10098 continue;
10099 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000010100
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010101 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010102 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010103
10104 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
10105 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
10106 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
10107 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
10108 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
10109 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
10110 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
10111 continue;
10112 }
10113 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
10114 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
10115 // See if this is an explicit destination.
10116 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10117 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
10118 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
10119 continue;
10120 }
10121
10122 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
10123 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
10124 continue;
10125 }
10126 }
10127
10128 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10129 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010130 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010131}
10132
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010133bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010134 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000010135 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010136
10137 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
10138 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010139
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010140 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010141 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
10142 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
10143 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010144 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010145 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000010146
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010147 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
10148 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
10149 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
10150 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
10151 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
10152 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
10153 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
10154 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000010155
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010156 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010157 ++NumDeadInst;
10158
10159 if (!I->use_empty())
10160 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
10161 I->eraseFromParent();
10162 }
10163 }
10164 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010165
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010166 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10167 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
10168 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010169
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010170 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010171 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010172 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010173 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010174 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010175 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010176
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010177 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010178
10179 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010180 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010181 continue;
10182 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010183
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010184 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000010185 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010186 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010187
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010188 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010189 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000010190 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
10191
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010192 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010193 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010194 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010195 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010196 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010197
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010198 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
10199 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10200 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
10201 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
10202 if (UserParent != BB) {
10203 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
10204 // See if the user is one of our successors.
10205 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
10206 if (*SI == UserParent) {
10207 UserIsSuccessor = true;
10208 break;
10209 }
10210
10211 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
10212 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
10213 // otherwise), we can keep going.
10214 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
10215 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
10216 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
10217 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
10218 }
10219 }
10220
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010221 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010222#ifndef NDEBUG
10223 std::string OrigI;
10224#endif
10225 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010226 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000010227 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010228 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010229 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010230 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
10231 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010232
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010233 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
10234 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
10235
10236 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010237 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010238 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010239
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010240 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
10241 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010242
10243 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
10244 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010245 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
10246
10247 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
10248 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
10249 ++InsertPos;
10250
10251 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010252
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010253 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
10254 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010255 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000010256
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010257 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
10258 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010259 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010260
10261 // Erase the old instruction.
10262 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010263 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010264#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010265 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
10266 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010267#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010268
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010269 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
10270 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010271 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
10272 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
10273 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010274 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010275
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010276 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010277 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010278 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010279 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010280 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010281 AddToWorkList(I);
10282 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010283 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010284 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010285 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010286 }
10287 }
10288
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010289 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000010290
10291 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
10292 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010293 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010294}
10295
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010296
10297bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010298 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
10299
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010300 bool EverMadeChange = false;
10301
10302 // Iterate while there is work to do.
10303 unsigned Iteration = 0;
10304 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
10305 EverMadeChange = true;
10306 return EverMadeChange;
10307}
10308
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000010309FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010310 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010311}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000010312